4b123ddb3848fd8a69c75688b1afbe16aa9bcaeb
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
148 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
151 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154
155 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
156 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
157 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
163 @value{GDBN}
164 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
165 how you can copy and share GDB
166 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
167 * Index:: Index
168 @end menu
169
170 @end ifnottex
171
172 @contents
173
174 @node Summary
175 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
176
177 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
178 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
179 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
180
181 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
182 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
183
184 @itemize @bullet
185 @item
186 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
187
188 @item
189 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
190
191 @item
192 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
193
194 @item
195 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
196 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
197 @end itemize
198
199 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
200 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
201 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
202
203 @cindex Modula-2
204 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
205 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
206
207 @cindex Pascal
208 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
209 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
210 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
211 syntax.
212
213 @cindex Fortran
214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
215 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
216 underscore.
217
218 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
219 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
220
221 @menu
222 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
223 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
224 @end menu
225
226 @node Free Software
227 @unnumberedsec Free Software
228
229 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
230 General Public License
231 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
232 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
233 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
234 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
235 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
236 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
237
238 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
239 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
240 from anyone else.
241
242 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
243
244 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
245 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
246 include with the free software. Many of our most important
247 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
248 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
249 when an important free software package does not come with a free
250 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
251 gaps today.
252
253 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
254 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
255 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
256 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
257 them from the free software world.
258
259 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
260 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
261 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
262 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
263 contract to make it non-free.
264
265 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
266 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
267 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
268 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
269 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
270 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
271 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
272
273 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
274 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
275 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
276 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
277
278 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
279 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
280 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
281 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
282 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
283 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
284 community.
285
286 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
287 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
288 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
289 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
290 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
291 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
292 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
293 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
294 of the manual.
295
296 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
297 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
298 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
299 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
300 manual to replace it.
301
302 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
303 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
304 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
305 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
306 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
307 the free software community.
308
309 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
310 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
311 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
312 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
313 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
314 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
315 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
316 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
317 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
318
319 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
320 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
321 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
322 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
323 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
324 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
325 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
326 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
327
328 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
329 published by other publishers, at
330 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
331
332 @node Contributors
333 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
334
335 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
336 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
337 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
338 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
339 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
340 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
341 blow-by-blow account.
342
343 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
344
345 @quotation
346 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
347 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
348 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
349 @end quotation
350
351 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
352 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
353 releases:
354 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
355 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
356 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
357 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
358 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
359 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
360 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
361 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
362 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
363
364 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
365 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
366
367 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
368 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
369 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
370 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
371 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
372
373 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
374 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
375 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
376
377 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
378 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
379
380 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
381
382 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
383 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
384 support.
385 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
386 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
387 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
388 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
389 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
390 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
391 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
392 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
393 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
394 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
395 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
396 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
397 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
398 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
399 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
400 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
401
402 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
403
404 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
405 libraries.
406
407 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
408 about several machine instruction sets.
409
410 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
411 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
412 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
413 and RDI targets, respectively.
414
415 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
416 command-line editing and command history.
417
418 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
419 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
420
421 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
422 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
423 symbols.
424
425 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
426 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
427
428 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
429
430 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
431 processors.
432
433 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
434
435 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
436
437 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
438
439 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
440 watchpoints.
441
442 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
443
444 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
445
446 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
447 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
448
449 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
450 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
451 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
452 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
453 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
454 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
455 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
456
457 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
458 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
459
460 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
461 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
462 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
463 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
464 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
465 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
466 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
467 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
468 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
469 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
470 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
471 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
472 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
473 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
474 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
475
476 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
477 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
478
479 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
480 Hat.
481
482 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
483 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
484 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
485 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
486 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
487 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
488
489 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
490 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
491 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
492 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
493 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
494 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
495 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
496 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
497 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
498 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
499 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
500 Weigand.
501
502 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
503 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
504 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
505 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
506
507 @node Sample Session
508 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
509
510 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
511 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
512 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
513
514 @iftex
515 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
516 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
517 @end iftex
518
519 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
520 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
521
522 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
523 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
524 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
525 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
526 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
527 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
528 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
529 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
530 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
531
532 @smallexample
533 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
534 $ @b{./m4}
535 @b{define(foo,0000)}
536
537 @b{foo}
538 0000
539 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
540
541 @b{bar}
542 0000
543 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
544
545 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
546 @b{baz}
547 @b{Ctrl-d}
548 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
549 @end smallexample
550
551 @noindent
552 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
553
554 @smallexample
555 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
556 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
557 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
558 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
559 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
560 the conditions.
561 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
562 for details.
563
564 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
565 (@value{GDBP})
566 @end smallexample
567
568 @noindent
569 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
570 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
571 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
572 that examples fit in this manual.
573
574 @smallexample
575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
576 @end smallexample
577
578 @noindent
579 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
580 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
581 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
582 @code{break} command.
583
584 @smallexample
585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
586 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
587 @end smallexample
588
589 @noindent
590 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
591 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
592 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
593
594 @smallexample
595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
596 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
597 @b{define(foo,0000)}
598
599 @b{foo}
600 0000
601 @end smallexample
602
603 @noindent
604 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
605 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
606 context where it stops.
607
608 @smallexample
609 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
610
611 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
612 at builtin.c:879
613 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
614 @end smallexample
615
616 @noindent
617 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
618 the next line of the current function.
619
620 @smallexample
621 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
622 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
623 : nil,
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
628 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
629 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
630 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
631
632 @smallexample
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
635 at input.c:530
636 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
637 @end smallexample
638
639 @noindent
640 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
641 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
642 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
643 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
644 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
645 stack frame for each active subroutine.
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
649 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
650 at input.c:530
651 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
652 at builtin.c:882
653 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
654 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
655 at macro.c:71
656 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
657 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
658 @end smallexample
659
660 @noindent
661 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
662 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
663 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
664
665 @smallexample
666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
667 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
669 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
670 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
671 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
672 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
673 : xstrdup(rq);
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
676 @end smallexample
677
678 @noindent
679 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
680 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
681 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
682 (@code{print}) to see their values.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
686 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
688 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
689 @end smallexample
690
691 @noindent
692 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
693 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
694 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
695
696 @smallexample
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
698 533 xfree(rquote);
699 534
700 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
701 : xstrdup (lq);
702 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
703 : xstrdup (rq);
704 537
705 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
706 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
707 540 @}
708 541
709 542 void
710 @end smallexample
711
712 @noindent
713 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
714 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
715
716 @smallexample
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
718 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
720 540 @}
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
722 $3 = 9
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
724 $4 = 7
725 @end smallexample
726
727 @noindent
728 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
729 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
730 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
731 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
732 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
733 assignments.
734
735 @smallexample
736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
737 $5 = 7
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
739 $6 = 9
740 @end smallexample
741
742 @noindent
743 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
744 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
745 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
746 example that caused trouble initially:
747
748 @smallexample
749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
750 Continuing.
751
752 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
753
754 baz
755 0000
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
760 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
761 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
762
763 @smallexample
764 @b{Ctrl-d}
765 Program exited normally.
766 @end smallexample
767
768 @noindent
769 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
770 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
771 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
772
773 @smallexample
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
775 @end smallexample
776
777 @node Invocation
778 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
779
780 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
781 The essentials are:
782 @itemize @bullet
783 @item
784 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
785 @item
786 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
787 @end itemize
788
789 @menu
790 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
791 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
792 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
793 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
794 @end menu
795
796 @node Invoking GDB
797 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
798
799 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
800 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
801
802 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
803 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
804
805 The command-line options described here are designed
806 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
807 options may effectively be unavailable.
808
809 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
810 specifying an executable program:
811
812 @smallexample
813 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
814 @end smallexample
815
816 @noindent
817 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
818 specified:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
825 to debug a running process:
826
827 @smallexample
828 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
829 @end smallexample
830
831 @noindent
832 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
833 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
834
835 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
836 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
837 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
838 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
839 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
840
841 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
842 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
843 option processing.
844 @smallexample
845 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
846 @end smallexample
847 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
848 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
849
850 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
851 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
852
853 @smallexample
854 @value{GDBP} -silent
855 @end smallexample
856
857 @noindent
858 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
859 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
860
861 @noindent
862 Type
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} -help
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
870 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
871
872 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
873 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
874 @samp{-x} option is used.
875
876
877 @menu
878 * File Options:: Choosing files
879 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
880 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
881 @end menu
882
883 @node File Options
884 @subsection Choosing Files
885
886 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
887 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
888 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
889 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
890 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
891 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
892 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
893 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
894 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
895 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
896 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
897 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
898 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
899
900 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
901 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
902 argument and ignore it.
903
904 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
905 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
906 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
907 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
908 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
909
910 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
911 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
912 @c it.
913
914 @table @code
915 @item -symbols @var{file}
916 @itemx -s @var{file}
917 @cindex @code{--symbols}
918 @cindex @code{-s}
919 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
920
921 @item -exec @var{file}
922 @itemx -e @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--exec}
924 @cindex @code{-e}
925 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
926 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
927
928 @item -se @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--se}
930 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
931 file.
932
933 @item -core @var{file}
934 @itemx -c @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--core}
936 @cindex @code{-c}
937 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
938
939 @item -c @var{number}
940 @item -pid @var{number}
941 @itemx -p @var{number}
942 @cindex @code{--pid}
943 @cindex @code{-p}
944 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
945 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
946 file named @var{number}.
947
948 @item -command @var{file}
949 @itemx -x @var{file}
950 @cindex @code{--command}
951 @cindex @code{-x}
952 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
953 Files,, Command files}.
954
955 @item -eval-command @var{command}
956 @itemx -ex @var{command}
957 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
958 @cindex @code{-ex}
959 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
960
961 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
962 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
963
964 @smallexample
965 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
966 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
967 @end smallexample
968
969 @item -directory @var{directory}
970 @itemx -d @var{directory}
971 @cindex @code{--directory}
972 @cindex @code{-d}
973 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
974
975 @item -r
976 @itemx -readnow
977 @cindex @code{--readnow}
978 @cindex @code{-r}
979 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
980 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
981 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
982
983 @end table
984
985 @node Mode Options
986 @subsection Choosing Modes
987
988 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
989 batch mode or quiet mode.
990
991 @table @code
992 @item -nx
993 @itemx -n
994 @cindex @code{--nx}
995 @cindex @code{-n}
996 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
997 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
998 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
999 Files}.
1000
1001 @item -quiet
1002 @itemx -silent
1003 @itemx -q
1004 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1005 @cindex @code{--silent}
1006 @cindex @code{-q}
1007 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1008 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1009
1010 @item -batch
1011 @cindex @code{--batch}
1012 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1013 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1014 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1015 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1016 in the command files.
1017
1018 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1019 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1020 make this more useful, the message
1021
1022 @smallexample
1023 Program exited normally.
1024 @end smallexample
1025
1026 @noindent
1027 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1028 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1029 mode.
1030
1031 @item -batch-silent
1032 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1033 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1034 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1035 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1036 for an interactive session.
1037
1038 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1039 messages, for example.
1040
1041 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1042 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1043
1044 @item -return-child-result
1045 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1046 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1047 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1048
1049 @itemize @bullet
1050 @item
1051 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1052 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1053 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1054 @item
1055 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1056 @item
1057 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1058 the exit code will be -1.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1062 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1063 interface.
1064
1065 @item -nowindows
1066 @itemx -nw
1067 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1068 @cindex @code{-nw}
1069 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1070 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1071 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1072
1073 @item -windows
1074 @itemx -w
1075 @cindex @code{--windows}
1076 @cindex @code{-w}
1077 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1078 used if possible.
1079
1080 @item -cd @var{directory}
1081 @cindex @code{--cd}
1082 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1083 instead of the current directory.
1084
1085 @item -fullname
1086 @itemx -f
1087 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1088 @cindex @code{-f}
1089 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1090 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1091 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1092 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1093 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1094 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1095 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1096 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1097 frame.
1098
1099 @item -epoch
1100 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1101 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1102 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1103 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1104 separate window.
1105
1106 @item -annotate @var{level}
1107 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1108 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1109 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1110 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1111 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1112 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1113 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1114 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1115 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1116
1117 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1118 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1119
1120 @item --args
1121 @cindex @code{--args}
1122 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1123 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1124 This option stops option processing.
1125
1126 @item -baud @var{bps}
1127 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1128 @cindex @code{--baud}
1129 @cindex @code{-b}
1130 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1131 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1132
1133 @item -l @var{timeout}
1134 @cindex @code{-l}
1135 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1136 for remote debugging.
1137
1138 @item -tty @var{device}
1139 @itemx -t @var{device}
1140 @cindex @code{--tty}
1141 @cindex @code{-t}
1142 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1143 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1144
1145 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1146 @item -tui
1147 @cindex @code{--tui}
1148 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1149 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1150 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1151 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1152 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1153 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1154 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1155
1156 @c @item -xdb
1157 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1158 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1159 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1160 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1161 @c systems.
1162
1163 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1164 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1165 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1166 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1167 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1168 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1169
1170 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1171 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1172 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1173 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1174 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1175 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1176
1177 @item -write
1178 @cindex @code{--write}
1179 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1180 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1181 (@pxref{Patching}).
1182
1183 @item -statistics
1184 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1185 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1186 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1187
1188 @item -version
1189 @cindex @code{--version}
1190 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1191 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1192
1193 @end table
1194
1195 @node Startup
1196 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1197 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1198
1199 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1200
1201 @enumerate
1202 @item
1203 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1204 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1205
1206 @item
1207 @cindex init file
1208 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1209 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1210 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1211 that file.
1212
1213 @item
1214 Processes command line options and operands.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1218 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1219 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1220 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1221 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1222 @value{GDBN}.
1223
1224 @item
1225 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1226 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1227
1228 @item
1229 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1230 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1231 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1232 @end enumerate
1233
1234 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1235 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1236 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1237 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1238 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1239 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1240
1241 @cindex init file name
1242 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1243 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1244 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1245 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1246 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1247 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1248 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1249 the file to the standard name.
1250
1251
1252 @node Quitting GDB
1253 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1254 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1255 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1256
1257 @table @code
1258 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1259 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1260 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1261 @itemx q
1262 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1263 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1264 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1265 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1266 error code.
1267 @end table
1268
1269 @cindex interrupt
1270 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1271 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1272 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1273 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1274 until a time when it is safe.
1275
1276 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1277 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1278 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1279
1280 @node Shell Commands
1281 @section Shell Commands
1282
1283 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1284 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1285 just use the @code{shell} command.
1286
1287 @table @code
1288 @kindex shell
1289 @cindex shell escape
1290 @item shell @var{command string}
1291 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1292 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1293 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1294 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1295 @end table
1296
1297 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1298 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1299 @value{GDBN}:
1300
1301 @table @code
1302 @kindex make
1303 @cindex calling make
1304 @item make @var{make-args}
1305 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1306 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1307 @end table
1308
1309 @node Logging Output
1310 @section Logging Output
1311 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1312 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1313
1314 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1315 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1316
1317 @table @code
1318 @kindex set logging
1319 @item set logging on
1320 Enable logging.
1321 @item set logging off
1322 Disable logging.
1323 @cindex logging file name
1324 @item set logging file @var{file}
1325 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1326 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1327 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1328 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1329 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1331 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1332 @kindex show logging
1333 @item show logging
1334 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1335 @end table
1336
1337 @node Commands
1338 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1339
1340 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1341 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1342 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1343 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1344 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1345
1346 @menu
1347 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1348 * Completion:: Command completion
1349 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1350 @end menu
1351
1352 @node Command Syntax
1353 @section Command Syntax
1354
1355 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1356 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1357 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1358 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1359 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1360 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1361
1362 @cindex abbreviation
1363 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1364 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1365 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1366 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1367 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1368 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1369 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1370
1371 @cindex repeating commands
1372 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1373 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1374 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1375 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1376 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1377 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1378 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1379
1380 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1381 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1382 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1383
1384 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1385 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1386 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1387 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1388 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1389
1390 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1391 @cindex comment
1392 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1393 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1394 Files,,Command Files}).
1395
1396 @cindex repeating command sequences
1397 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1398 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1399 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1400 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1401 for editing.
1402
1403 @node Completion
1404 @section Command Completion
1405
1406 @cindex completion
1407 @cindex word completion
1408 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1409 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1410 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1411 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1412
1413 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1414 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1415 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1416 enter it). For example, if you type
1417
1418 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1419 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1420 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1421 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1422 @smallexample
1423 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1424 @end smallexample
1425
1426 @noindent
1427 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1428 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1429
1430 @smallexample
1431 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1432 @end smallexample
1433
1434 @noindent
1435 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1436 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1437 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1438 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1439 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1440 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1441
1442 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1443 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1444 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1445 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1446 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1447 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1448 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1449 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1450 example:
1451
1452 @smallexample
1453 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1454 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1455 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1456 make_abs_section make_function_type
1457 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1458 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1459 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1460 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1461 @end smallexample
1462
1463 @noindent
1464 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1465 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1466 command.
1467
1468 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1469 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1470 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1471 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1472 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1473
1474 @cindex quotes in commands
1475 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1476 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1477 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1478 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1479 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1480 @value{GDBN} commands.
1481
1482 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1483 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1484 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1485 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1486 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1487 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1488 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1489 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1490 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1491 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1492 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1493
1494 @smallexample
1495 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1496 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1497 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1498 @end smallexample
1499
1500 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1501 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1502 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1503 place:
1504
1505 @smallexample
1506 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1507 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1508 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1509 @end smallexample
1510
1511 @noindent
1512 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1513 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1514 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1515
1516 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1517 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1518 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1519 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1520
1521
1522 @node Help
1523 @section Getting Help
1524 @cindex online documentation
1525 @kindex help
1526
1527 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1528 using the command @code{help}.
1529
1530 @table @code
1531 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1532 @item help
1533 @itemx h
1534 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1535 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1536
1537 @smallexample
1538 (@value{GDBP}) help
1539 List of classes of commands:
1540
1541 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1542 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1543 data -- Examining data
1544 files -- Specifying and examining files
1545 internals -- Maintenance commands
1546 obscure -- Obscure features
1547 running -- Running the program
1548 stack -- Examining the stack
1549 status -- Status inquiries
1550 support -- Support facilities
1551 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1552 stopping the program
1553 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1554
1555 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1556 commands in that class.
1557 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1558 documentation.
1559 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1560 (@value{GDBP})
1561 @end smallexample
1562 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1563
1564 @item help @var{class}
1565 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1566 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1567 help display for the class @code{status}:
1568
1569 @smallexample
1570 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1571 Status inquiries.
1572
1573 List of commands:
1574
1575 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1576 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1577 info -- Generic command for showing things
1578 about the program being debugged
1579 show -- Generic command for showing things
1580 about the debugger
1581
1582 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1583 documentation.
1584 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1585 (@value{GDBP})
1586 @end smallexample
1587
1588 @item help @var{command}
1589 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1590 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1591
1592 @kindex apropos
1593 @item apropos @var{args}
1594 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1595 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1596 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1597
1598 @smallexample
1599 apropos reload
1600 @end smallexample
1601
1602 @noindent
1603 results in:
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 @c @group
1607 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1608 multiple times in one run
1609 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1610 multiple times in one run
1611 @c @end group
1612 @end smallexample
1613
1614 @kindex complete
1615 @item complete @var{args}
1616 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1617 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1618 command you want completed. For example:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 complete i
1622 @end smallexample
1623
1624 @noindent results in:
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 @group
1628 if
1629 ignore
1630 info
1631 inspect
1632 @end group
1633 @end smallexample
1634
1635 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1636 @end table
1637
1638 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1639 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1640 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1641 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1642 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1643 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1644
1645 @c @group
1646 @table @code
1647 @kindex info
1648 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1649 @item info
1650 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1651 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1652 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1653 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1654 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1655 @w{@code{help info}}.
1656
1657 @kindex set
1658 @item set
1659 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1660 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1661 @code{set prompt $}.
1662
1663 @kindex show
1664 @item show
1665 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1666 @value{GDBN} itself.
1667 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1668 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1669 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1670 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1671
1672 @kindex info set
1673 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1674 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1675 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1676 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1677 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1678 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1679 @end table
1680 @c @end group
1681
1682 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1683 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1684
1685 @table @code
1686 @kindex show version
1687 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1688 @item show version
1689 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1690 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1691 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1692 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1693 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1694 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1695 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1696 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1697 @value{GDBN}.
1698
1699 @kindex show copying
1700 @kindex info copying
1701 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1702 @item show copying
1703 @itemx info copying
1704 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1705
1706 @kindex show warranty
1707 @kindex info warranty
1708 @item show warranty
1709 @itemx info warranty
1710 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1711 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1712
1713 @end table
1714
1715 @node Running
1716 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1717
1718 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1719 debugging information when you compile it.
1720
1721 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1722 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1723 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1724 kill a child process.
1725
1726 @menu
1727 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1728 * Starting:: Starting your program
1729 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1730 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1731
1732 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1733 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1734 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1735 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1736
1737 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1738 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1739 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1740 @end menu
1741
1742 @node Compilation
1743 @section Compiling for Debugging
1744
1745 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1746 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1747 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1748 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1749 and addresses in the executable code.
1750
1751 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1752 the compiler.
1753
1754 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1755 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1756 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1757 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1758 executables containing debugging information.
1759
1760 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1761 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1762 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1763 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1764 in pushing your luck.
1765
1766 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1767 @cindex debugging optimized code
1768 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1769 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1770 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1771 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1772 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1773 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1774
1775 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1776 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1777 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1778 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1779 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1780
1781 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1782 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1783 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1784
1785 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1786 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1787 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1788 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1789 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1790 provides macro information if you specify the options
1791 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1792 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1793 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1794 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1795 @option{-g} alone.
1796
1797 @need 2000
1798 @node Starting
1799 @section Starting your Program
1800 @cindex starting
1801 @cindex running
1802
1803 @table @code
1804 @kindex run
1805 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1806 @item run
1807 @itemx r
1808 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1809 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1810 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1811 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1812 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1813
1814 @end table
1815
1816 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1817 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1818 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1819 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1820
1821 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1822 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1823 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1824 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1825 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1826 divided into four categories:
1827
1828 @table @asis
1829 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1830 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1831 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1832 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1833 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1834 the arguments.
1835 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1836 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1837 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1838
1839 @item The @emph{environment.}
1840 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1841 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1842 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1843 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1844
1845 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1846 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1847 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1848 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1849
1850 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1851 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1852 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1853 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1854 set a different device for your program.
1855 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1856
1857 @cindex pipes
1858 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1859 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1860 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1861 wrong program.
1862 @end table
1863
1864 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1865 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1866 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1867 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1868 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1869
1870 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1871 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1872 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1873 your current breakpoints.
1874
1875 @table @code
1876 @kindex start
1877 @item start
1878 @cindex run to main procedure
1879 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1880 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1881 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1882 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1883 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1884 procedure, depending on the language used.
1885
1886 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1887 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1888 the @samp{run} command.
1889
1890 @cindex elaboration phase
1891 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1892 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1893 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1894 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1895 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1896 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1897 will remain to halt execution.
1898
1899 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1900 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1901 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1902 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1903 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1904
1905 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1906 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1907 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1908 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1909 elaboration code before running your program.
1910 @end table
1911
1912 @node Arguments
1913 @section Your Program's Arguments
1914
1915 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1916 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1917 @code{run} command.
1918 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1919 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1920 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1921 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1922 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1923
1924 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1925 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1926 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1927 the program, not by the shell.
1928
1929 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1930 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1931
1932 @table @code
1933 @kindex set args
1934 @item set args
1935 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1936 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1937 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1938 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1939 it again without arguments.
1940
1941 @kindex show args
1942 @item show args
1943 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1944 @end table
1945
1946 @node Environment
1947 @section Your Program's Environment
1948
1949 @cindex environment (of your program)
1950 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1951 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1952 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1953 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1954 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1955 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1956 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1957
1958 @table @code
1959 @kindex path
1960 @item path @var{directory}
1961 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1962 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1963 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1964 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1965 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1966 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1967 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1968
1969 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1970 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1971 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1972 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1973 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1974 @var{directory} to the search path.
1975 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1976 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1977
1978 @kindex show paths
1979 @item show paths
1980 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1981 environment variable).
1982
1983 @kindex show environment
1984 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1985 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1986 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1987 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1988 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1989
1990 @kindex set environment
1991 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1992 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1993 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1994 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1995 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1996 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1997 null value.
1998 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1999 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2000
2001 For example, this command:
2002
2003 @smallexample
2004 set env USER = foo
2005 @end smallexample
2006
2007 @noindent
2008 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2009 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2010 are not actually required.)
2011
2012 @kindex unset environment
2013 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2014 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2015 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2016 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2017 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2018 @end table
2019
2020 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2021 the shell indicated
2022 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2023 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2024 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2025 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2026 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2027 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2028 @file{.profile}.
2029
2030 @node Working Directory
2031 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2032
2033 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2034 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2035 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2036 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2037 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2038 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2039
2040 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2041 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2042 Specify Files}.
2043
2044 @table @code
2045 @kindex cd
2046 @cindex change working directory
2047 @item cd @var{directory}
2048 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2049
2050 @kindex pwd
2051 @item pwd
2052 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2053 @end table
2054
2055 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2056 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2057 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2058 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2059 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2060 current working directory of the debuggee.
2061
2062 @node Input/Output
2063 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2064
2065 @cindex redirection
2066 @cindex i/o
2067 @cindex terminal
2068 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2069 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2070 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2071 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2072 running your program.
2073
2074 @table @code
2075 @kindex info terminal
2076 @item info terminal
2077 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2078 program is using.
2079 @end table
2080
2081 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2082 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2083
2084 @smallexample
2085 run > outfile
2086 @end smallexample
2087
2088 @noindent
2089 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2090
2091 @kindex tty
2092 @cindex controlling terminal
2093 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2094 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2095 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2096 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2097 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2098
2099 @smallexample
2100 tty /dev/ttyb
2101 @end smallexample
2102
2103 @noindent
2104 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2105 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2106 that as their controlling terminal.
2107
2108 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2109 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2110 terminal.
2111
2112 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2113 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2114 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2115 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2116
2117 @cindex inferior tty
2118 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2119 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2120 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2121 program.
2122
2123 @table @code
2124 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2125 @kindex set inferior-tty
2126 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2127
2128 @item show inferior-tty
2129 @kindex show inferior-tty
2130 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2131 @end table
2132
2133 @node Attach
2134 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2135 @kindex attach
2136 @cindex attach
2137
2138 @table @code
2139 @item attach @var{process-id}
2140 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2141 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2142 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2143 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2144 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2145
2146 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2147 executing the command.
2148 @end table
2149
2150 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2151 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2152 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2153 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2154
2155 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2156 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2157 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2158 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2159 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2160 Specify Files}.
2161
2162 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2163 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2164 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2165 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2166 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2167 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2168 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2169
2170 @table @code
2171 @kindex detach
2172 @item detach
2173 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2174 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2175 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2176 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2177 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2178 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2179 executing the command.
2180 @end table
2181
2182 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2183 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2184 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2185 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2186 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2187 Messages}).
2188
2189 @node Kill Process
2190 @section Killing the Child Process
2191
2192 @table @code
2193 @kindex kill
2194 @item kill
2195 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2196 @end table
2197
2198 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2199 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2200 is running.
2201
2202 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2203 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2204 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2205 outside the debugger.
2206
2207 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2208 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2209 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2210 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2211 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2212 breakpoint settings).
2213
2214 @node Threads
2215 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2216
2217 @cindex threads of execution
2218 @cindex multiple threads
2219 @cindex switching threads
2220 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2221 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2222 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2223 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2224 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2225 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2226 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2227
2228 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2229 programs:
2230
2231 @itemize @bullet
2232 @item automatic notification of new threads
2233 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2234 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2235 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2236 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2237 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2238 @end itemize
2239
2240 @quotation
2241 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2242 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2243 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2244 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2245 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2246 like this:
2247
2248 @smallexample
2249 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2250 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2251 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2252 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2253 @end smallexample
2254 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2255 @c doesn't support threads"?
2256 @end quotation
2257
2258 @cindex focus of debugging
2259 @cindex current thread
2260 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2261 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2262 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2263 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2264 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2265
2266 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2267 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2268 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2269 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2270 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2271 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2272 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2273 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2274 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2275 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2276
2277 @smallexample
2278 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2279 @end smallexample
2280
2281 @noindent
2282 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2283 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2284 further qualifier.
2285
2286 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2287 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2288 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2289 @c program?
2290 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2291 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2292 @c threads ab initio?
2293
2294 @cindex thread number
2295 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2296 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2297 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2298
2299 @table @code
2300 @kindex info threads
2301 @item info threads
2302 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2303 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2304
2305 @enumerate
2306 @item
2307 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2308
2309 @item
2310 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2311
2312 @item
2313 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2314 @end enumerate
2315
2316 @noindent
2317 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2318 indicates the current thread.
2319
2320 For example,
2321 @end table
2322 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2323
2324 @smallexample
2325 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2326 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2327 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2328 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2329 at threadtest.c:68
2330 @end smallexample
2331
2332 On HP-UX systems:
2333
2334 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2335 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2336 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2337 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2338 thread in your program.
2339
2340 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2341 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2342 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2343 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2344 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2345 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2346 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2347 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2348 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2349 HP-UX, you see
2350
2351 @smallexample
2352 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2353 @end smallexample
2354
2355 @noindent
2356 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2360 @item info threads
2361 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2362 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2363
2364 @enumerate
2365 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2366
2367 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2368
2369 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2370 @end enumerate
2371
2372 @noindent
2373 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2374 indicates the current thread.
2375
2376 For example,
2377 @end table
2378 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2379
2380 @smallexample
2381 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2382 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2383 at quicksort.c:137
2384 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2385 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2386 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2387 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2388 @end smallexample
2389
2390 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2391 Solaris-specific command:
2392
2393 @table @code
2394 @item maint info sol-threads
2395 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2396 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2397 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2398 @end table
2399
2400 @table @code
2401 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2402 @item thread @var{threadno}
2403 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2404 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2405 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2406 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2407 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2408
2409 @smallexample
2410 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2411 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2412 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2413 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2414 @end smallexample
2415
2416 @noindent
2417 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2418 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2419 threads.
2420
2421 @kindex thread apply
2422 @cindex apply command to several threads
2423 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2424 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2425 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2426 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2427 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2428 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2429 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2430 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 @cindex automatic thread selection
2434 @cindex switching threads automatically
2435 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2436 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2437 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2438 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2439 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2440 thread.
2441
2442 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2443 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2444 programs with multiple threads.
2445
2446 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2447 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2448
2449 @node Processes
2450 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2451
2452 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2453 @cindex multiple processes
2454 @cindex processes, multiple
2455 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2456 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2457 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2458 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2459 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2460 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2461 will cause it to terminate.
2462
2463 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2464 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2465 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2466 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2467 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2468 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2469 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2470 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2471 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2472 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2473
2474 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2475 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2476 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2477 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2478
2479 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2480 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2481
2482 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2483 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2484
2485 @table @code
2486 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2487 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2488 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2489 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2490 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2491
2492 @table @code
2493 @item parent
2494 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2495 unimpeded. This is the default.
2496
2497 @item child
2498 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2499 unimpeded.
2500
2501 @end table
2502
2503 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2504 @item show follow-fork-mode
2505 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2506 @end table
2507
2508 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2509 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2510 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2511
2512 @table @code
2513 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2514 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2515 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2516 retain debugger control over them both.
2517
2518 @table @code
2519 @item on
2520 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2521 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2522 independently. This is the default.
2523
2524 @item off
2525 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2526 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2527 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2528 is held suspended.
2529
2530 @end table
2531
2532 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2533 @item show detach-on-follow
2534 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2535 @end table
2536
2537 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2538 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2539 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2540 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2541 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info forks
2545 @item info forks
2546 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2547 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2548 position (program counter) of the process.
2549
2550
2551 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2552 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2553 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2554 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2555 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2556
2557 @end table
2558
2559 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2560 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2561 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2562 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2563
2564 @table @code
2565 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2566 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2567 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2568 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2569 allowed to run independently.
2570
2571 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2572 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2573 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2574 and remove it from the fork list.
2575
2576 @end table
2577
2578 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2579 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2580 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2581 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2582 the child process's @code{main}.
2583
2584 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2585 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2586
2587 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2588 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2589 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2590 argument.
2591
2592 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2593 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2594 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2595
2596 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2597 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2598
2599 @cindex checkpoint
2600 @cindex restart
2601 @cindex bookmark
2602 @cindex snapshot of a process
2603 @cindex rewind program state
2604
2605 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2606 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2607 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2608 later.
2609
2610 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2611 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2612 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2613 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2614 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2615
2616 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2617 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2618 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2619 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2620 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2621 start again from there.
2622
2623 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2624 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2625
2626 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2627
2628 @table @code
2629 @kindex checkpoint
2630 @item checkpoint
2631 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2632 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2633 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2634
2635 @kindex info checkpoints
2636 @item info checkpoints
2637 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2638 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2639 listed:
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @item Checkpoint ID
2643 @item Process ID
2644 @item Code Address
2645 @item Source line, or label
2646 @end table
2647
2648 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2649 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2650 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2651 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2652 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2653 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2654 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2655
2656 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2657 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2658 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2659 the debugger.
2660
2661 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2662 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2663 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2664
2665 @end table
2666
2667 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2668 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2669 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2670 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2671 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2672 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2673 previously read data can be read again.
2674
2675 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2676 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2677 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2678 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2679 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2680 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2681
2682 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2683 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2684 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2685 different execution path this time.
2686
2687 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2688 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2689 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2690 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2691 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2692 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2693 potentially pose a problem.
2694
2695 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2696
2697 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2698 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2699 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2700 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2701 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2702 next.
2703
2704 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2705 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2706 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2707 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2708 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2709
2710 @node Stopping
2711 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2712
2713 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2714 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2715 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2716
2717 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2718 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2719 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2720 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2721 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2722 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2723 explicitly request this information at any time.
2724
2725 @table @code
2726 @kindex info program
2727 @item info program
2728 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2729 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2730 @end table
2731
2732 @menu
2733 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2734 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2735 * Signals:: Signals
2736 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2737 @end menu
2738
2739 @node Breakpoints
2740 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2741
2742 @cindex breakpoints
2743 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2744 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2745 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2746 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2747 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2748 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2749 program.
2750
2751 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2752 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2753 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2754 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2755 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2756 call).
2757
2758 @cindex watchpoints
2759 @cindex data breakpoints
2760 @cindex memory tracing
2761 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2762 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2763 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2764 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2765 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2766 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2767 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2768 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2769 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2770 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2771 same commands.
2772
2773 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2774 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2775 Automatic Display}.
2776
2777 @cindex catchpoints
2778 @cindex breakpoint on events
2779 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2780 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2781 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2782 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2783 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2784 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2785 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2786
2787 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2788 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2789 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2790 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2791 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2792 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2793 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2794 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2795 enable it again.
2796
2797 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2798 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2799 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2800 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2801 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2802 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2803 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2804
2805 @menu
2806 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2807 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2808 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2809 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2810 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2811 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2812 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2813 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2814 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2815 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2816 @end menu
2817
2818 @node Set Breaks
2819 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2820
2821 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2822 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2823 @c
2824 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2825
2826 @kindex break
2827 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2828 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2829 @cindex latest breakpoint
2830 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2831 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2832 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2833 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2834 convenience variables.
2835
2836 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2837
2838 @table @code
2839 @item break @var{function}
2840 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2841 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2842 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2843 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2844
2845 @item break +@var{offset}
2846 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2847 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2848 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2849 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2850
2851 @item break @var{linenum}
2852 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2853 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2854 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2855 code on that line.
2856
2857 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2858 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2859
2860 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2861 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2862 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2863 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2864 functions.
2865
2866 @item break *@var{address}
2867 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2868 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2869 information or source files.
2870
2871 @item break
2872 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2873 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2874 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2875 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2876 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2877 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2878 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2879 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2880 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2881 inside loops.
2882
2883 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2884 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2885 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2886 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2887 existed when your program stopped.
2888
2889 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2890 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2891 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2892 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2893 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2894 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2895 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2896
2897 @kindex tbreak
2898 @item tbreak @var{args}
2899 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2900 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2901 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2902 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2903
2904 @kindex hbreak
2905 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2906 @item hbreak @var{args}
2907 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2908 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2909 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2910 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2911 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2912 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2913 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2914 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2915 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2916 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2917 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2918 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2919 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2920 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2921 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2922 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2923 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2924 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2925
2926
2927 @kindex thbreak
2928 @item thbreak @var{args}
2929 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2930 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2931 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2932 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2933 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2934 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2935 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2936 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2937
2938 @kindex rbreak
2939 @cindex regular expression
2940 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2941 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2942 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2943 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2944 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2945 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2946 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2947 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2948 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2949
2950 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2951 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2952 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2953 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2954 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2955 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2956
2957 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2958 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2959 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2960 classes.
2961
2962 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2963 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2964 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2965
2966 @smallexample
2967 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2968 @end smallexample
2969
2970 @kindex info breakpoints
2971 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2972 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2973 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2974 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2975 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2976 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2977 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2978 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2979
2980 @table @emph
2981 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2982 @item Type
2983 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2984 @item Disposition
2985 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2986 @item Enabled or Disabled
2987 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2988 that are not enabled.
2989 @item Address
2990 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
2991 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
2992 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
2993 @item What
2994 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2995 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
2996 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
2997 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
2998 @end table
2999
3000 @noindent
3001 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3002 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3003 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3004 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3005 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3006 valid location.
3007
3008 @noindent
3009 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3010 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3011 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3012 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3013 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3014
3015 @noindent
3016 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3017 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3018 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3019 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3020 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3021 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3022 @end table
3023
3024 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3025 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3026 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3027 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3028
3029 @cindex pending breakpoints
3030 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3031 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3032 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3033 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3034 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3035 gets loaded.
3036
3037 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3038 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3039 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3040 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3041 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3042 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3043
3044 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3045 breakpoint support:
3046
3047 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3048 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3049 @table @code
3050 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3051 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3052 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3053
3054 @item set breakpoint pending on
3055 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3056 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3057
3058 @item set breakpoint pending off
3059 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3060 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3061 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3062
3063 @item show breakpoint pending
3064 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3065 @end table
3066
3067 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3068 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3069 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3070 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3071 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3072 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3073 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3074 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3075 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3076 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3077 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3078 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3079 of these loads could resolve the location.
3080
3081 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3082 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3083 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3084 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3085 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3086 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3087 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3088 breakpoints.
3089
3090 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3091
3092 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3093 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3094 @table @code
3095 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3096 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3097 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3098 breakpoint must be used.
3099
3100 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3101 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3102 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3103 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3104 @end table
3105
3106
3107 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3108 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3109 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3110 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3111 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3112 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3113 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3114 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3115
3116
3117 @node Set Watchpoints
3118 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3119
3120 @cindex setting watchpoints
3121 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3122 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3123 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3124 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3125 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3126
3127 @itemize @bullet
3128 @item
3129 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3130
3131 @item
3132 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3133 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3134 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3135
3136 @item
3137 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3138 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3139 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3140 @end itemize
3141
3142 @cindex software watchpoints
3143 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3144 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3145 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3146 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3147 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3148 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3149 culprit.)
3150
3151 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3152 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3153 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3154
3155 @table @code
3156 @kindex watch
3157 @item watch @var{expr}
3158 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3159 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3160 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3161 to watch the value of a single variable:
3162
3163 @smallexample
3164 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3165 @end smallexample
3166
3167 @kindex rwatch
3168 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3169 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3170 by the program.
3171
3172 @kindex awatch
3173 @item awatch @var{expr}
3174 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3175 or written into by the program.
3176
3177 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3178 @item info watchpoints
3179 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3180 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3181 @end table
3182
3183 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3184 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3185 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3186 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3187 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3188 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3189
3190 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3191 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3192 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3193 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3194 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3195 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3196 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3197 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3198
3199 @table @code
3200 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3201 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3202 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3203
3204 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3205 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3206 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3207 @end table
3208
3209 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3210 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3211 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3212
3213 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3214
3215 @smallexample
3216 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3217 @end smallexample
3218
3219 @noindent
3220 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3221
3222 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3223 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3224 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3225 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3226 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3227 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3228 will print a message like this:
3229
3230 @smallexample
3231 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3232 @end smallexample
3233
3234 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3235 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3236 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3237 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3238 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3239 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3240 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3241 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3242
3243 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3244 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3245 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3246 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3247 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3248 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3249
3250 @smallexample
3251 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3252 @end smallexample
3253
3254 @noindent
3255 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3256
3257 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3258 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3259 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3260 expression with separately allocated resources.
3261
3262 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3263 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3264 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3265 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3266 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3267 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3268 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3269 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3270 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3271 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3272
3273 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3274 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3275 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3276
3277 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3278 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3279 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3280 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3281 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3282 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3283 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3284 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3285 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3286
3287 @quotation
3288 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3289 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3290 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3291 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3292 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3293 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3294 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3295 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3296 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3297 the expression.
3298
3299 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3300 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3301 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3302 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3303 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3304 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3305 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3306 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3307 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3308 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3309 @end quotation
3310
3311 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3312
3313 @node Set Catchpoints
3314 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3315 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3316 @cindex exception handlers
3317 @cindex event handling
3318
3319 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3320 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3321 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3322
3323 @table @code
3324 @kindex catch
3325 @item catch @var{event}
3326 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3327 @table @code
3328 @item throw
3329 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3330 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3331
3332 @item catch
3333 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3334
3335 @item exception
3336 @cindex Ada exception catching
3337 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3338 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3339 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3340 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3341 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3342
3343 @item exception unhandled
3344 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3345
3346 @item assert
3347 A failed Ada assertion.
3348
3349 @item exec
3350 @cindex break on fork/exec
3351 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3352
3353 @item fork
3354 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3355
3356 @item vfork
3357 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3358
3359 @item load
3360 @itemx load @var{libname}
3361 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3362 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3363 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3364
3365 @item unload
3366 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3367 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3368 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3369 @end table
3370
3371 @item tcatch @var{event}
3372 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3373 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3374
3375 @end table
3376
3377 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3378
3379 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3380 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3381
3382 @itemize @bullet
3383 @item
3384 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3385 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3386 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3387 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3388 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3389 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3390 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3391 disabled within interactive calls.
3392
3393 @item
3394 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3395
3396 @item
3397 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3398 @end itemize
3399
3400 @cindex raise exceptions
3401 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3402 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3403 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3404 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3405 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3406 out where the exception was raised.
3407
3408 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3409 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3410 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3411 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3412
3413 @smallexample
3414 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3415 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3416 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3417 @end smallexample
3418
3419 @noindent
3420 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3421 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3422 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3423
3424 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3425 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3426 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3427 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3428 raised.
3429
3430
3431 @node Delete Breaks
3432 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3433
3434 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3435 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3436 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3437 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3438 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3439 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3440
3441 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3442 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3443 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3444 their breakpoint numbers.
3445
3446 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3447 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3448 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3449
3450 @table @code
3451 @kindex clear
3452 @item clear
3453 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3454 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3455 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3456 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3457
3458 @item clear @var{function}
3459 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3460 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3461
3462 @item clear @var{linenum}
3463 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3464 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3465 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3466
3467 @cindex delete breakpoints
3468 @kindex delete
3469 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3470 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3471 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3472 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3473 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3474 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3475 @end table
3476
3477 @node Disabling
3478 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3479
3480 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3481 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3482 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3483 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3484 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3485
3486 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3487 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3488 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3489 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3490 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3491
3492 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3493 states of enablement:
3494
3495 @itemize @bullet
3496 @item
3497 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3498 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3499 @item
3500 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3501 @item
3502 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3503 disabled.
3504 @item
3505 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3506 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3507 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3508 @end itemize
3509
3510 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3511 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3512
3513 @table @code
3514 @kindex disable
3515 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3516 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3517 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3518 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3519 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3520 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3521 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3522
3523 @kindex enable
3524 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3525 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3526 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3527
3528 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3529 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3530 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3531
3532 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3533 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3534 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3535 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3536 @end table
3537
3538 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3539 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3540 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3541 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3542 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3543 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3544 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3545 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3546 Stepping}.)
3547
3548 @node Conditions
3549 @subsection Break Conditions
3550 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3551 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3552
3553 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3554 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3555 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3556 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3557 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3558 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3559 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3560 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3561
3562 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3563 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3564 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3565 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3566 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3567
3568 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3569 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3570 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3571 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3572 one.
3573
3574 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3575 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3576 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3577 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3578 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3579 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3580 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3581 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3582 conditions for the
3583 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3584 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3585
3586 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3587 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3588 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3589 with the @code{condition} command.
3590
3591 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3592 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3593 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3594 catchpoint.
3595
3596 @table @code
3597 @kindex condition
3598 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3599 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3600 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3601 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3602 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3603 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3604 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3605 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3606 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3607 prints an error message:
3608
3609 @smallexample
3610 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3611 @end smallexample
3612
3613 @noindent
3614 @value{GDBN} does
3615 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3616 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3617 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3618
3619 @item condition @var{bnum}
3620 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3621 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3622 @end table
3623
3624 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3625 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3626 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3627 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3628 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3629 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3630 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3631 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3632 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3633 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3634 your program reaches it.
3635
3636 @table @code
3637 @kindex ignore
3638 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3639 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3640 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3641 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3642 takes no action.
3643
3644 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3645 a count of zero.
3646
3647 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3648 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3649 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3650 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3651
3652 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3653 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3654 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3655
3656 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3657 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3658 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3659 Variables}.
3660 @end table
3661
3662 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3663
3664
3665 @node Break Commands
3666 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3667
3668 @cindex breakpoint commands
3669 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3670 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3671 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3672 enable other breakpoints.
3673
3674 @table @code
3675 @kindex commands
3676 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3677 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3678 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3679 @itemx end
3680 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3681 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3682 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3683
3684 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3685 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3686
3687 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3688 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3689 recently encountered).
3690 @end table
3691
3692 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3693 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3694
3695 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3696 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3697 that resumes execution.
3698
3699 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3700 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3701 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3702 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3703 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3704
3705 @kindex silent
3706 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3707 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3708 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3709 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3710 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3711 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3712
3713 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3714 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3715 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3716
3717 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3718 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3719
3720 @smallexample
3721 break foo if x>0
3722 commands
3723 silent
3724 printf "x is %d\n",x
3725 cont
3726 end
3727 @end smallexample
3728
3729 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3730 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3731 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3732 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3733 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3734 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3735 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3736
3737 @smallexample
3738 break 403
3739 commands
3740 silent
3741 set x = y + 4
3742 cont
3743 end
3744 @end smallexample
3745
3746 @node Breakpoint Menus
3747 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3748 @cindex overloading
3749 @cindex symbol overloading
3750
3751 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3752 single function name
3753 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3754 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3755 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3756 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3757 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3758 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3759 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3760 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3761 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3762 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3763 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3764 breakpoints.
3765
3766 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3767 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3768 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3769
3770 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3771 @smallexample
3772 @group
3773 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3774 [0] cancel
3775 [1] all
3776 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3777 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3778 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3779 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3780 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3781 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3782 > 2 4 6
3783 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3784 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3785 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3786 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3787 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3788 breakpoints.
3789 (@value{GDBP})
3790 @end group
3791 @end smallexample
3792
3793 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3794 @node Error in Breakpoints
3795 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3796 @c
3797 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3798 @c
3799 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3800 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3801 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3802 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3803
3804 @smallexample
3805 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3806 The same program may be running in another process.
3807 @end smallexample
3808
3809 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3810
3811 @enumerate
3812 @item
3813 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3814
3815 @item
3816 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3817 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3818 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3819 Then start your program again.
3820
3821 @item
3822 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3823 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3824 to nonsharable executables.
3825 @end enumerate
3826 @c @end ifclear
3827
3828 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3829 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3830
3831 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3832 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3833 @smallexample
3834 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3835 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3836 @end smallexample
3837
3838 @noindent
3839 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3840 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3841 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3842
3843 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3844 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3845
3846 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3847 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3848 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3849
3850 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3851 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3852 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3853 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3854
3855 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3856 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3857 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3858 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3859 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3860 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3861 first in the bundle.
3862
3863 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3864 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3865 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3866 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3867 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3868 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3869 is hit.
3870
3871 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3872 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3873
3874 @smallexample
3875 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3876 @end smallexample
3877
3878 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3879 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3880 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3881 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3882 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3883 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3884 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3885 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3886
3887 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3888 adjusted breakpoints:
3889
3890 @smallexample
3891 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3892 to 0x00010410.
3893 @end smallexample
3894
3895 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3896 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3897 frequently than expected.
3898
3899 @node Continuing and Stepping
3900 @section Continuing and Stepping
3901
3902 @cindex stepping
3903 @cindex continuing
3904 @cindex resuming execution
3905 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3906 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3907 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3908 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3909 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3910 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3911 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3912 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3913
3914 @table @code
3915 @kindex continue
3916 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3917 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3918 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3919 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3920 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3921 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3922 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3923 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3924 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3925 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3926
3927 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3928 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3929 @code{continue} is ignored.
3930
3931 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3932 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3933 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3934 @code{continue}.
3935 @end table
3936
3937 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3938 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
3939 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3940 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3941
3942 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3943 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
3944 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3945 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3946 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3947 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3948
3949 @table @code
3950 @kindex step
3951 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3952 @item step
3953 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3954 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3955 abbreviated @code{s}.
3956
3957 @quotation
3958 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3959 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3960 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3961 @c distinction here.
3962 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3963 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3964 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3965 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3966 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3967 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3968 below.
3969 @end quotation
3970
3971 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3972 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3973 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3974 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3975 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3976 called within the line.
3977
3978 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3979 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3980 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3981 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3982 was any debugging information about the routine.
3983
3984 @item step @var{count}
3985 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3986 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3987 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3988
3989 @kindex next
3990 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3991 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3992 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3993 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3994 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3995 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3996 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3997 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3998
3999 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4000
4001
4002 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4003 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4004 @c
4005 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4006 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4007 @c function are executed without stopping.
4008
4009 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4010 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4011 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4012
4013 @kindex set step-mode
4014 @item set step-mode
4015 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4016 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4017 @itemx set step-mode on
4018 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4019 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4020 information rather than stepping over it.
4021
4022 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4023 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4024 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4025
4026 @item set step-mode off
4027 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4028 debug information. This is the default.
4029
4030 @item show step-mode
4031 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4032 source line debug information.
4033
4034 @kindex finish
4035 @item finish
4036 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4037 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4038
4039 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4040 ,Returning from a Function}).
4041
4042 @kindex until
4043 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4044 @cindex run until specified location
4045 @item until
4046 @itemx u
4047 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4048 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4049 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4050 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4051 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4052 than the address of the jump.
4053
4054 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4055 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4056 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4057 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4058 through the next iteration.
4059
4060 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4061 stack frame.
4062
4063 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4064 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4065 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4066 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4067 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4068
4069 @smallexample
4070 (@value{GDBP}) f
4071 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4072 206 expand_input();
4073 (@value{GDBP}) until
4074 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4075 @end smallexample
4076
4077 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4078 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4079 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4080 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4081 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4082 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4083 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4084
4085 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4086 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4087 argument.
4088
4089 @item until @var{location}
4090 @itemx u @var{location}
4091 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4092 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4093 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4094 ,Setting Breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4095 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4096 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4097 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4098 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4099 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4100 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4101 invocations have returned.
4102
4103 @smallexample
4104 94 int factorial (int value)
4105 95 @{
4106 96 if (value > 1) @{
4107 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4108 98 @}
4109 99 return (value);
4110 100 @}
4111 @end smallexample
4112
4113
4114 @kindex advance @var{location}
4115 @itemx advance @var{location}
4116 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4117 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4118 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4119 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4120 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4121 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4122
4123
4124 @kindex stepi
4125 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4126 @item stepi
4127 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4128 @itemx si
4129 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4130
4131 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4132 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4133 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4134 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4135
4136 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4137
4138 @need 750
4139 @kindex nexti
4140 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4141 @item nexti
4142 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4143 @itemx ni
4144 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4145 proceed until the function returns.
4146
4147 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4148 @end table
4149
4150 @node Signals
4151 @section Signals
4152 @cindex signals
4153
4154 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4155 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4156 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4157 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4158 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4159 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4160 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4161 requested an alarm).
4162
4163 @cindex fatal signals
4164 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4165 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4166 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4167 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4168 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4169 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4170
4171 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4172 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4173 signal.
4174
4175 @cindex handling signals
4176 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4177 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4178 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4179 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4180 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4181
4182 @table @code
4183 @kindex info signals
4184 @kindex info handle
4185 @item info signals
4186 @itemx info handle
4187 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4188 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4189 the defined types of signals.
4190
4191 @item info signals @var{sig}
4192 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4193
4194 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4195
4196 @kindex handle
4197 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4198 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4199 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4200 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4201 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4202 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4203 say what change to make.
4204 @end table
4205
4206 @c @group
4207 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4208 Their full names are:
4209
4210 @table @code
4211 @item nostop
4212 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4213 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4214
4215 @item stop
4216 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4217 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4218
4219 @item print
4220 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4221
4222 @item noprint
4223 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4224 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4225
4226 @item pass
4227 @itemx noignore
4228 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4229 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4230 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4231
4232 @item nopass
4233 @itemx ignore
4234 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4235 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4236 @end table
4237 @c @end group
4238
4239 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4240 program until you
4241 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4242 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4243 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4244 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4245 program sees that signal when you continue.
4246
4247 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4248 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4249 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4250 erroneous signals.
4251
4252 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4253 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4254 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4255 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4256 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4257 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4258 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4259 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4260 Program a Signal}.
4261
4262 @node Thread Stops
4263 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4264
4265 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4266 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4267 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4268
4269 @table @code
4270 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4271 @cindex thread breakpoints
4272 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4273 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4274 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4275 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4276 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4277
4278 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4279 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4280 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4281 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4282 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4283
4284 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4285 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4286 program.
4287
4288 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4289 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4290 breakpoint condition, like this:
4291
4292 @smallexample
4293 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4294 @end smallexample
4295
4296 @end table
4297
4298 @cindex stopped threads
4299 @cindex threads, stopped
4300 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4301 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4302 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4303 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4304 underfoot.
4305
4306 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4307 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4308 @cindex premature return from system calls
4309 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4310 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4311 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4312 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4313 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4314 stop execution.
4315
4316 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4317 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4318 style anyways.
4319
4320 For example, do not write code like this:
4321
4322 @smallexample
4323 sleep (10);
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4327 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4328
4329 Instead, write this:
4330
4331 @smallexample
4332 int unslept = 10;
4333 while (unslept > 0)
4334 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4335 @end smallexample
4336
4337 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4338 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4339 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4340 @value{GDBN}.
4341
4342 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4343 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4344 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4345 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4346
4347 @cindex continuing threads
4348 @cindex threads, continuing
4349 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4350 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4351 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4352
4353 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4354 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4355 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4356 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4357 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4358 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4359 stops.
4360
4361 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4362 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4363 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4364 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4365
4366 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4367 thread to run.
4368
4369 @table @code
4370 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4371 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4372 @cindex lock scheduler
4373 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4374 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4375 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4376 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4377 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4378 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4379 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4380 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4381 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4382 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4383 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4384
4385 @item show scheduler-locking
4386 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4387 @end table
4388
4389
4390 @node Stack
4391 @chapter Examining the Stack
4392
4393 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4394 stopped and how it got there.
4395
4396 @cindex call stack
4397 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4398 is generated.
4399 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4400 the arguments of the call,
4401 and the local variables of the function being called.
4402 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4403 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4404 stack}.
4405
4406 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4407 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4408
4409 @cindex selected frame
4410 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4411 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4412 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4413 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4414 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4415 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4416
4417 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4418 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4419 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4420
4421 @menu
4422 * Frames:: Stack frames
4423 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4424 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4425 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4426
4427 @end menu
4428
4429 @node Frames
4430 @section Stack Frames
4431
4432 @cindex frame, definition
4433 @cindex stack frame
4434 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4435 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4436 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4437 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4438 which the function is executing.
4439
4440 @cindex initial frame
4441 @cindex outermost frame
4442 @cindex innermost frame
4443 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4444 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4445 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4446 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4447 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4448 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4449 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4450 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4451
4452 @cindex frame pointer
4453 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4454 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4455 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4456 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4457 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4458 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4459
4460 @cindex frame number
4461 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4462 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4463 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4464 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4465 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4466
4467 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4468 @c underflow problems.
4469 @cindex frameless execution
4470 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4471 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4472 @smallexample
4473 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4474 @end smallexample
4475 generates functions without a frame.)
4476 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4477 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4478 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4479 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4480 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4481 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4482 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4483
4484 @table @code
4485 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4486 @cindex current stack frame
4487 @item frame @var{args}
4488 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4489 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4490 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4491 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4492
4493 @kindex select-frame
4494 @cindex selecting frame silently
4495 @item select-frame
4496 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4497 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4498 @code{frame}.
4499 @end table
4500
4501 @node Backtrace
4502 @section Backtraces
4503
4504 @cindex traceback
4505 @cindex call stack traces
4506 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4507 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4508 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4509 stack.
4510
4511 @table @code
4512 @kindex backtrace
4513 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4514 @item backtrace
4515 @itemx bt
4516 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4517 frames in the stack.
4518
4519 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4520 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4521
4522 @item backtrace @var{n}
4523 @itemx bt @var{n}
4524 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4525
4526 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4527 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4528 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4529
4530 @item backtrace full
4531 @itemx bt full
4532 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4533 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4534 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4535 number of frames to print, as described above.
4536 @end table
4537
4538 @kindex where
4539 @kindex info stack
4540 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4541 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4542
4543 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4544 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4545 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4546 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4547 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4548 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4549 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4550 multi-threaded program.
4551
4552 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4553 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4554 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4555 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4556 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4557 line number.
4558
4559 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4560 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4561
4562 @smallexample
4563 @group
4564 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4565 at builtin.c:993
4566 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4567 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4568 at macro.c:71
4569 (More stack frames follow...)
4570 @end group
4571 @end smallexample
4572
4573 @noindent
4574 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4575 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4576 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4577
4578 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4579 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4580 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4581 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4582 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4583 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4584 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4585 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4586 such a backtrace might look like:
4587
4588 @smallexample
4589 @group
4590 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4591 at builtin.c:993
4592 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4593 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4594 at macro.c:71
4595 (More stack frames follow...)
4596 @end group
4597 @end smallexample
4598
4599 @noindent
4600 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4601 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4602
4603 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4604 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4605 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4606
4607 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4608 @cindex program entry point
4609 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4610 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4611 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4612 @code{main}@footnote{
4613 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4614 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4615 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4616 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4617 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4618 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4619
4620 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4621 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4622
4623 @table @code
4624 @item set backtrace past-main
4625 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4626 @kindex set backtrace
4627 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4628
4629 @item set backtrace past-main off
4630 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4631 default.
4632
4633 @item show backtrace past-main
4634 @kindex show backtrace
4635 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4636
4637 @item set backtrace past-entry
4638 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4639 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4640 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4641 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4642
4643 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4644 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4645 application. This is the default.
4646
4647 @item show backtrace past-entry
4648 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4649
4650 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4651 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4652 @cindex backtrace limit
4653 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4654 unlimited.
4655
4656 @item show backtrace limit
4657 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4658 @end table
4659
4660 @node Selection
4661 @section Selecting a Frame
4662
4663 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4664 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4665 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4666 of the stack frame just selected.
4667
4668 @table @code
4669 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4670 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4671 @item frame @var{n}
4672 @itemx f @var{n}
4673 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4674 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4675 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4676 @code{main}.
4677
4678 @item frame @var{addr}
4679 @itemx f @var{addr}
4680 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4681 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4682 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4683 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4684 switches between them.
4685
4686 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4687 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4688
4689 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4690 pointer and a program counter.
4691
4692 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4693 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4694
4695 @kindex up
4696 @item up @var{n}
4697 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4698 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4699 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4700
4701 @kindex down
4702 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4703 @item down @var{n}
4704 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4705 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4706 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4707 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4708 @end table
4709
4710 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4711 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4712 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4713 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4714
4715 @need 1000
4716 For example:
4717
4718 @smallexample
4719 @group
4720 (@value{GDBP}) up
4721 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4722 at env.c:10
4723 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4724 @end group
4725 @end smallexample
4726
4727 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4728 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4729 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4730 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4731 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4732 for details.
4733
4734 @table @code
4735 @kindex down-silently
4736 @kindex up-silently
4737 @item up-silently @var{n}
4738 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4739 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4740 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4741 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4742 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4743 distracting.
4744 @end table
4745
4746 @node Frame Info
4747 @section Information About a Frame
4748
4749 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4750 stack frame.
4751
4752 @table @code
4753 @item frame
4754 @itemx f
4755 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4756 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4757 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4758 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4759 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4760
4761 @kindex info frame
4762 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4763 @item info frame
4764 @itemx info f
4765 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4766 including:
4767
4768 @itemize @bullet
4769 @item
4770 the address of the frame
4771 @item
4772 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4773 @item
4774 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4775 @item
4776 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4777 @item
4778 the address of the frame's arguments
4779 @item
4780 the address of the frame's local variables
4781 @item
4782 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4783 @item
4784 which registers were saved in the frame
4785 @end itemize
4786
4787 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4788 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4789 the usual conventions.
4790
4791 @item info frame @var{addr}
4792 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4793 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4794 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4795 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4796 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4797 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4798
4799 @kindex info args
4800 @item info args
4801 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4802
4803 @item info locals
4804 @kindex info locals
4805 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4806 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4807 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4808
4809 @kindex info catch
4810 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4811 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4812 @item info catch
4813 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4814 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4815 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4816 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4817 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4818
4819 @end table
4820
4821
4822 @node Source
4823 @chapter Examining Source Files
4824
4825 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4826 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4827 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4828 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4829 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4830 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4831 source files by explicit command.
4832
4833 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4834 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4835 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4836
4837 @menu
4838 * List:: Printing source lines
4839 * Edit:: Editing source files
4840 * Search:: Searching source files
4841 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4842 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4843 @end menu
4844
4845 @node List
4846 @section Printing Source Lines
4847
4848 @kindex list
4849 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4850 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4851 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4852 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4853
4854 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4855
4856 @table @code
4857 @item list @var{linenum}
4858 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4859 current source file.
4860
4861 @item list @var{function}
4862 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4863 @var{function}.
4864
4865 @item list
4866 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4867 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4868 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4869 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4870 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4871
4872 @item list -
4873 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4874 @end table
4875
4876 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4877 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4878 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4879
4880 @table @code
4881 @kindex set listsize
4882 @item set listsize @var{count}
4883 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4884 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4885
4886 @kindex show listsize
4887 @item show listsize
4888 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4889 @end table
4890
4891 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4892 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4893 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4894 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4895 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4896
4897 @cindex linespec
4898 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4899 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4900 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4901 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4902
4903 @table @code
4904 @item list @var{linespec}
4905 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4906
4907 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4908 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4909 linespecs.
4910
4911 @item list ,@var{last}
4912 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4913
4914 @item list @var{first},
4915 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4916
4917 @item list +
4918 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4919
4920 @item list -
4921 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4922
4923 @item list
4924 As described in the preceding table.
4925 @end table
4926
4927 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4928 kinds of linespec.
4929
4930 @table @code
4931 @item @var{number}
4932 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4933 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4934 the same source file as the first linespec.
4935
4936 @item +@var{offset}
4937 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4938 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4939 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4940 first linespec.
4941
4942 @item -@var{offset}
4943 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4944
4945 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4946 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4947
4948 @item @var{function}
4949 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4950 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4951
4952 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4953 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4954 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4955 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4956 identically named functions in different source files.
4957
4958 @item *@var{address}
4959 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4960 @var{address} may be any expression.
4961 @end table
4962
4963 @node Edit
4964 @section Editing Source Files
4965 @cindex editing source files
4966
4967 @kindex edit
4968 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4969 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4970 The editing program of your choice
4971 is invoked with the current line set to
4972 the active line in the program.
4973 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4974 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4975
4976 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4977
4978 @table @code
4979 @item edit
4980 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4981
4982 @item edit @var{number}
4983 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4984
4985 @item edit @var{function}
4986 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4987
4988 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4989 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4990
4991 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4992 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4993 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4994 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4995 identically named functions in different source files.
4996
4997 @item edit *@var{address}
4998 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4999 @var{address} may be any expression.
5000 @end table
5001
5002 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5003 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5004 @footnote{
5005 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5006 following command-line syntax:
5007 @smallexample
5008 ex +@var{number} file
5009 @end smallexample
5010 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5011 the file where to start editing.}.
5012 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5013 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5014 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5015 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5016 @smallexample
5017 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5018 export EDITOR
5019 gdb @dots{}
5020 @end smallexample
5021 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5022 @smallexample
5023 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5024 gdb @dots{}
5025 @end smallexample
5026
5027 @node Search
5028 @section Searching Source Files
5029 @cindex searching source files
5030
5031 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5032 regular expression.
5033
5034 @table @code
5035 @kindex search
5036 @kindex forward-search
5037 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5038 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5039 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5040 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5041 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5042 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5043 @code{fo}.
5044
5045 @kindex reverse-search
5046 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5047 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5048 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5049 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5050 this command as @code{rev}.
5051 @end table
5052
5053 @node Source Path
5054 @section Specifying Source Directories
5055
5056 @cindex source path
5057 @cindex directories for source files
5058 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5059 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5060 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5061 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5062 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5063 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5064 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5065
5066 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5067 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5068 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5069 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5070 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5071 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5072 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5073 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5074 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5075 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5076 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5077
5078 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5079 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5080 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5081 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5082 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5083 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5084
5085 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5086 source files.
5087
5088 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5089 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5090 each line is in the file.
5091
5092 @kindex directory
5093 @kindex dir
5094 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5095 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5096 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5097
5098 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5099 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5100
5101 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5102 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5103 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5104 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5105 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5106 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5107 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5108 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5109 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5110 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5111 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5112 name to look up the sources.
5113
5114 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5115 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5116 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5117 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5118 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5119 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5120 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5121 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5122
5123 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5124 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5125 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5126 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5127 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5128 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5129 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5130
5131 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5132 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5133 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5134 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5135 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5136 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5137 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5138 command.
5139
5140 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5141 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5142 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5143 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5144 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5145 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5146 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5147
5148 @table @code
5149 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5150 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5151 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5152 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5153 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5154 part of absolute file names) or
5155 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5156 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5157
5158 @kindex cdir
5159 @kindex cwd
5160 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5161 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5162 @cindex compilation directory
5163 @cindex current directory
5164 @cindex working directory
5165 @cindex directory, current
5166 @cindex directory, compilation
5167 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5168 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5169 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5170 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5171 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5172 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5173
5174 @item directory
5175 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5176
5177 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5178 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5179
5180 @item show directories
5181 @kindex show directories
5182 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5183
5184 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5185 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5186 @kindex set substitute-path
5187 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5188 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5189 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5190
5191 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5192 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5193
5194 @smallexample
5195 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5196 @end smallexample
5197
5198 @noindent
5199 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5200 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5201 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5202
5203 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5204 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5205 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5206 the substitution.
5207
5208 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5209
5210 @smallexample
5211 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5212 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5213 @end smallexample
5214
5215 @noindent
5216 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5217 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5218 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5219 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5220
5221
5222 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5223 @kindex unset substitute-path
5224 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5225 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5226 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5227
5228 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5229
5230 @item show substitute-path [path]
5231 @kindex show substitute-path
5232 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5233 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5234
5235 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5236 rules.
5237
5238 @end table
5239
5240 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5241 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5242 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5243
5244 @enumerate
5245 @item
5246 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5247
5248 @item
5249 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5250 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5251 directories in one command.
5252 @end enumerate
5253
5254 @node Machine Code
5255 @section Source and Machine Code
5256 @cindex source line and its code address
5257
5258 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5259 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5260 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5261 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5262 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5263 well as hex.
5264
5265 @table @code
5266 @kindex info line
5267 @item info line @var{linespec}
5268 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5269 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5270 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5271 Source Lines}).
5272 @end table
5273
5274 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5275 the object code for the first line of function
5276 @code{m4_changequote}:
5277
5278 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5279 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5280 @smallexample
5281 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5282 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5283 @end smallexample
5284
5285 @noindent
5286 @cindex code address and its source line
5287 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5288 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5289 @smallexample
5290 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5291 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5292 @end smallexample
5293
5294 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5295 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5296 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5297 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5298 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5299 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5300 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5301 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5302 Variables}).
5303
5304 @table @code
5305 @kindex disassemble
5306 @cindex assembly instructions
5307 @cindex instructions, assembly
5308 @cindex machine instructions
5309 @cindex listing machine instructions
5310 @item disassemble
5311 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5312 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5313 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5314 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5315 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5316 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5317 @end table
5318
5319 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5320 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5321
5322 @smallexample
5323 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5324 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5325 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5326 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5327 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5328 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5329 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5330 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5331 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5332 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5333 End of assembler dump.
5334 @end smallexample
5335
5336 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5337 mnemonics or other syntax.
5338
5339 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5340 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5341 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5342 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5343 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5344
5345 @table @code
5346 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5347 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5348 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5349 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5350 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5351 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5352
5353 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5354 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5355 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5356 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5357
5358 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5359 @item show disassembly-flavor
5360 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5361 @end table
5362
5363
5364 @node Data
5365 @chapter Examining Data
5366
5367 @cindex printing data
5368 @cindex examining data
5369 @kindex print
5370 @kindex inspect
5371 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5372 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5373 @c different window or something like that.
5374 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5375 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5376 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5377 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5378 Different Languages}).
5379
5380 @table @code
5381 @item print @var{expr}
5382 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5383 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5384 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5385 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5386 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5387 Formats}.
5388
5389 @item print
5390 @itemx print /@var{f}
5391 @cindex reprint the last value
5392 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5393 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5394 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5395 @end table
5396
5397 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5398 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5399 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5400
5401 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5402 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5403 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5404 Table}.
5405
5406 @menu
5407 * Expressions:: Expressions
5408 * Variables:: Program variables
5409 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5410 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5411 * Memory:: Examining memory
5412 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5413 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5414 * Value History:: Value history
5415 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5416 * Registers:: Registers
5417 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5418 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5419 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5420 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5421 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5422 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5423 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5424 character set than GDB does
5425 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5426 @end menu
5427
5428 @node Expressions
5429 @section Expressions
5430
5431 @cindex expressions
5432 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5433 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5434 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5435 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5436 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5437 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5438 @ref{Compilation}.
5439
5440 @cindex arrays in expressions
5441 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5442 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5443 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5444 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5445
5446 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5447 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5448 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5449 languages.
5450
5451 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5452 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5453
5454 @cindex casts, in expressions
5455 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5456 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5457 at that address in memory.
5458 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5459
5460 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5461 to programming languages:
5462
5463 @table @code
5464 @item @@
5465 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5466 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5467
5468 @item ::
5469 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5470 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5471
5472 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5473 @cindex type casting memory
5474 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5475 @cindex casts, to view memory
5476 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5477 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5478 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5479 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5480 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5481 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5482 @end table
5483
5484 @node Variables
5485 @section Program Variables
5486
5487 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5488 in your program.
5489
5490 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5491 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5492
5493 @itemize @bullet
5494 @item
5495 global (or file-static)
5496 @end itemize
5497
5498 @noindent or
5499
5500 @itemize @bullet
5501 @item
5502 visible according to the scope rules of the
5503 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5504 @end itemize
5505
5506 @noindent This means that in the function
5507
5508 @smallexample
5509 foo (a)
5510 int a;
5511 @{
5512 bar (a);
5513 @{
5514 int b = test ();
5515 bar (b);
5516 @}
5517 @}
5518 @end smallexample
5519
5520 @noindent
5521 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5522 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5523 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5524 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5525
5526 @cindex variable name conflict
5527 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5528 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5529 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5530 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5531 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5532 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5533 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5534
5535 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5536 @ifnotinfo
5537 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5538 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5539 @end ifnotinfo
5540 @smallexample
5541 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5542 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5543 @end smallexample
5544
5545 @noindent
5546 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5547 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5548 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5549 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5550
5551 @smallexample
5552 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5553 @end smallexample
5554
5555 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5556 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5557 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5558 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5559 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5560 @c conflict?? --mew
5561
5562 @cindex wrong values
5563 @cindex variable values, wrong
5564 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5565 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5566 @quotation
5567 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5568 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5569 scope, and just before exit.
5570 @end quotation
5571 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5572 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5573 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5574 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5575 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5576 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5577 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5578 variable definitions may be gone.
5579
5580 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5581 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5582 when compiling.
5583
5584 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5585 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5586 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5587 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5588 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5589 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5590 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5591
5592 @smallexample
5593 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5594 @end smallexample
5595
5596 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5597 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5598 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5599 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5600 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5601 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5602 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5603 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5604 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5605 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5606 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5607
5608 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5609 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5610 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5611 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5612
5613 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5614 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5615 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5616 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5617 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5618 For program code
5619
5620 @smallexample
5621 char var0[] = "A";
5622 signed char var1[] = "A";
5623 @end smallexample
5624
5625 You get during debugging
5626 @smallexample
5627 (gdb) print var0
5628 $1 = "A"
5629 (gdb) print var1
5630 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5631 @end smallexample
5632
5633 @node Arrays
5634 @section Artificial Arrays
5635
5636 @cindex artificial array
5637 @cindex arrays
5638 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5639 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5640 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5641 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5642 program.
5643
5644 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5645 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5646 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5647 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5648 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5649 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5650 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5651 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5652 example. If a program says
5653
5654 @smallexample
5655 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5656 @end smallexample
5657
5658 @noindent
5659 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5660
5661 @smallexample
5662 p *array@@len
5663 @end smallexample
5664
5665 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5666 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5667 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5668 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5669 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5670
5671 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5672 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5673 The value need not be in memory:
5674 @smallexample
5675 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5676 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5677 @end smallexample
5678
5679 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5680 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5681 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5682 @smallexample
5683 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5684 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5685 @end smallexample
5686
5687 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5688 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5689 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5690 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5691 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5692 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5693 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5694 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5695 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5696 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5697
5698 @smallexample
5699 set $i = 0
5700 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5701 @key{RET}
5702 @key{RET}
5703 @dots{}
5704 @end smallexample
5705
5706 @node Output Formats
5707 @section Output Formats
5708
5709 @cindex formatted output
5710 @cindex output formats
5711 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5712 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5713 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5714 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5715 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5716
5717 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5718 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5719 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5720 letters supported are:
5721
5722 @table @code
5723 @item x
5724 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5725 hexadecimal.
5726
5727 @item d
5728 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5729
5730 @item u
5731 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5732
5733 @item o
5734 Print as integer in octal.
5735
5736 @item t
5737 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5738 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5739 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5740 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5741
5742 @item a
5743 @cindex unknown address, locating
5744 @cindex locate address
5745 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5746 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5747 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5748
5749 @smallexample
5750 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5751 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5752 @end smallexample
5753
5754 @noindent
5755 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5756 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5757
5758 @item c
5759 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5760 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5761 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5762 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5763
5764 @item f
5765 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5766 using typical floating point syntax.
5767 @end table
5768
5769 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5770
5771 @smallexample
5772 p/x $pc
5773 @end smallexample
5774
5775 @noindent
5776 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5777 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5778
5779 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5780 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5781 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5782
5783 @node Memory
5784 @section Examining Memory
5785
5786 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5787 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5788
5789 @cindex examining memory
5790 @table @code
5791 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5792 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5793 @itemx x @var{addr}
5794 @itemx x
5795 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5796 @end table
5797
5798 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5799 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5800 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5801 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5802 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5803
5804 @table @r
5805 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5806 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5807 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5808 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5809 @c 4.1.2.
5810
5811 @item @var{f}, the display format
5812 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5813 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5814 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5815 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5816 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5817 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5818
5819 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5820 The unit size is any of
5821
5822 @table @code
5823 @item b
5824 Bytes.
5825 @item h
5826 Halfwords (two bytes).
5827 @item w
5828 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5829 @item g
5830 Giant words (eight bytes).
5831 @end table
5832
5833 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5834 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5835 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5836
5837 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5838 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5839 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5840 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5841 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5842 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5843 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5844 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5845 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5846 a value from memory).
5847 @end table
5848
5849 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5850 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5851 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5852 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5853 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5854
5855 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5856 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5857 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5858 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5859 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5860
5861 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5862 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5863 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5864 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5865 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5866 Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
5867
5868 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5869 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5870 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5871 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5872 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5873 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5874 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5875
5876 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5877 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5878 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5879 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5880 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5881 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5882 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5883 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5884 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5885
5886 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5887 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5888 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5889
5890 @cindex remote memory comparison
5891 @cindex verify remote memory image
5892 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5893 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5894 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5895 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5896 situations.
5897
5898 @table @code
5899 @kindex compare-sections
5900 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5901 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5902 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5903 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5904 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5905 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5906 remote request.
5907 @end table
5908
5909 @node Auto Display
5910 @section Automatic Display
5911 @cindex automatic display
5912 @cindex display of expressions
5913
5914 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5915 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5916 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5917 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5918 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5919 The automatic display looks like this:
5920
5921 @smallexample
5922 2: foo = 38
5923 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5924 @end smallexample
5925
5926 @noindent
5927 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5928 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5929 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5930 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5931 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5932 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5933 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5934
5935 @table @code
5936 @kindex display
5937 @item display @var{expr}
5938 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5939 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5940
5941 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5942
5943 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5944 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5945 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5946 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5947 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
5948
5949 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5950 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5951 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5952 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5953 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5954 @end table
5955
5956 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5957 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5958 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5959
5960 @table @code
5961 @kindex delete display
5962 @kindex undisplay
5963 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5964 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5965 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5966
5967 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5968 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5969
5970 @kindex disable display
5971 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5972 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5973 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5974 enabled again later.
5975
5976 @kindex enable display
5977 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5978 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5979 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5980
5981 @item display
5982 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5983 done when your program stops.
5984
5985 @kindex info display
5986 @item info display
5987 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5988 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5989 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5990 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5991 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5992 @end table
5993
5994 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5995 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5996 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5997 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5998 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5999 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6000 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6001 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6002 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6003 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6004 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6005
6006 @node Print Settings
6007 @section Print Settings
6008
6009 @cindex format options
6010 @cindex print settings
6011 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6012 and symbols are printed.
6013
6014 @noindent
6015 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6016
6017 @table @code
6018 @kindex set print
6019 @item set print address
6020 @itemx set print address on
6021 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6022 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6023 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6024 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6025 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6026 @code{set print address on}:
6027
6028 @smallexample
6029 @group
6030 (@value{GDBP}) f
6031 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6032 at input.c:530
6033 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6034 @end group
6035 @end smallexample
6036
6037 @item set print address off
6038 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6039 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6040
6041 @smallexample
6042 @group
6043 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6044 (@value{GDBP}) f
6045 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6046 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6047 @end group
6048 @end smallexample
6049
6050 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6051 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6052 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6053 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6054
6055 @kindex show print
6056 @item show print address
6057 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6058 @end table
6059
6060 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6061 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6062 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6063 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6064 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6065 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6066 it prints a symbolic address:
6067
6068 @table @code
6069 @item set print symbol-filename on
6070 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6071 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6072 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6073 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6074
6075 @item set print symbol-filename off
6076 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6077 default.
6078
6079 @item show print symbol-filename
6080 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6081 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6082 @end table
6083
6084 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6085 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6086 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6087
6088 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6089 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6090
6091 @table @code
6092 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6093 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6094 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6095 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6096 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6097 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6098
6099 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6100 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6101 symbolic address.
6102 @end table
6103
6104 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6105 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6106 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6107 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6108 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6109 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6110 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6111 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6112
6113 @smallexample
6114 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6115 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6116 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6117 @end smallexample
6118
6119 @quotation
6120 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6121 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6122 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6123 @end quotation
6124
6125 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6126
6127 @table @code
6128 @item set print array
6129 @itemx set print array on
6130 @cindex pretty print arrays
6131 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6132 but uses more space. The default is off.
6133
6134 @item set print array off
6135 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6136
6137 @item show print array
6138 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6139 arrays.
6140
6141 @cindex print array indexes
6142 @item set print array-indexes
6143 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6144 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6145 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6146 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6147
6148 @item set print array-indexes off
6149 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6150
6151 @item show print array-indexes
6152 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6153 arrays.
6154
6155 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6156 @cindex number of array elements to print
6157 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6158 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6159 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6160 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6161 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6162 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6163 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6164
6165 @item show print elements
6166 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6167 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6168
6169 @item set print repeats
6170 @cindex repeated array elements
6171 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6172 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6173 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6174 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6175 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6176 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6177 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6178
6179 @item show print repeats
6180 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6181 elements.
6182
6183 @item set print null-stop
6184 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6185 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6186 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6187 contain only short strings.
6188 The default is off.
6189
6190 @item show print null-stop
6191 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6192 @sc{null} character.
6193
6194 @item set print pretty on
6195 @cindex print structures in indented form
6196 @cindex indentation in structure display
6197 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6198 per line, like this:
6199
6200 @smallexample
6201 @group
6202 $1 = @{
6203 next = 0x0,
6204 flags = @{
6205 sweet = 1,
6206 sour = 1
6207 @},
6208 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6209 @}
6210 @end group
6211 @end smallexample
6212
6213 @item set print pretty off
6214 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6215
6216 @smallexample
6217 @group
6218 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6219 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6220 @end group
6221 @end smallexample
6222
6223 @noindent
6224 This is the default format.
6225
6226 @item show print pretty
6227 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6228
6229 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6230 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6231 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6232 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6233 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6234 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6235 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6236 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6237
6238 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6239 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6240 international character sets, and is the default.
6241
6242 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6243 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6244
6245 @item set print union on
6246 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6247 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6248 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6249
6250 @item set print union off
6251 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6252 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6253 instead.
6254
6255 @item show print union
6256 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6257 structures and other unions.
6258
6259 For example, given the declarations
6260
6261 @smallexample
6262 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6263 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6264 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6265 Bug_forms;
6266
6267 struct thing @{
6268 Species it;
6269 union @{
6270 Tree_forms tree;
6271 Bug_forms bug;
6272 @} form;
6273 @};
6274
6275 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6276 @end smallexample
6277
6278 @noindent
6279 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6280
6281 @smallexample
6282 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6283 @end smallexample
6284
6285 @noindent
6286 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6287
6288 @smallexample
6289 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6290 @end smallexample
6291
6292 @noindent
6293 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6294 and in Pascal.
6295 @end table
6296
6297 @need 1000
6298 @noindent
6299 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6300
6301 @table @code
6302 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6303 @item set print demangle
6304 @itemx set print demangle on
6305 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6306 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6307 linkage. The default is on.
6308
6309 @item show print demangle
6310 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6311
6312 @item set print asm-demangle
6313 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6314 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6315 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6316 The default is off.
6317
6318 @item show print asm-demangle
6319 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6320 or demangled form.
6321
6322 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6323 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6324 @kindex set demangle-style
6325 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6326 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6327 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6328
6329 @table @code
6330 @item auto
6331 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6332
6333 @item gnu
6334 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6335 This is the default.
6336
6337 @item hp
6338 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6339
6340 @item lucid
6341 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6342
6343 @item arm
6344 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6345 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6346 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6347 require further enhancement to permit that.
6348
6349 @end table
6350 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6351
6352 @item show demangle-style
6353 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6354
6355 @item set print object
6356 @itemx set print object on
6357 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6358 @cindex display derived types
6359 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6360 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6361 the virtual function table.
6362
6363 @item set print object off
6364 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6365 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6366
6367 @item show print object
6368 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6369
6370 @item set print static-members
6371 @itemx set print static-members on
6372 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6373 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6374
6375 @item set print static-members off
6376 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6377
6378 @item show print static-members
6379 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6380
6381 @item set print pascal_static-members
6382 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6383 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6384 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6385 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6386
6387 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6388 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6389
6390 @item show print pascal_static-members
6391 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6392
6393 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6394 @item set print vtbl
6395 @itemx set print vtbl on
6396 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6397 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6398 @cindex VTBL display
6399 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6400 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6401 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6402
6403 @item set print vtbl off
6404 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6405
6406 @item show print vtbl
6407 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6408 @end table
6409
6410 @node Value History
6411 @section Value History
6412
6413 @cindex value history
6414 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6415 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6416 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6417 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6418 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6419 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6420 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6421 symbol table.
6422
6423 @cindex @code{$}
6424 @cindex @code{$$}
6425 @cindex history number
6426 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6427 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6428 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6429 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6430 history number.
6431
6432 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6433 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6434 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6435 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6436 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6437 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6438 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6439
6440 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6441 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6442
6443 @smallexample
6444 p *$
6445 @end smallexample
6446
6447 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6448 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6449
6450 @smallexample
6451 p *$.next
6452 @end smallexample
6453
6454 @noindent
6455 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6456 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6457
6458 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6459 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6460
6461 @smallexample
6462 print x
6463 set x=5
6464 @end smallexample
6465
6466 @noindent
6467 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6468 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6469
6470 @table @code
6471 @kindex show values
6472 @item show values
6473 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6474 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6475 values} does not change the history.
6476
6477 @item show values @var{n}
6478 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6479
6480 @item show values +
6481 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6482 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6483 @end table
6484
6485 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6486 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6487
6488 @node Convenience Vars
6489 @section Convenience Variables
6490
6491 @cindex convenience variables
6492 @cindex user-defined variables
6493 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6494 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6495 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6496 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6497 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6498
6499 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6500 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6501 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6502 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6503 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6504
6505 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6506 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6507 For example:
6508
6509 @smallexample
6510 set $foo = *object_ptr
6511 @end smallexample
6512
6513 @noindent
6514 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6515 @code{object_ptr}.
6516
6517 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6518 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6519 value with another assignment at any time.
6520
6521 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6522 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6523 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6524 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6525
6526 @table @code
6527 @kindex show convenience
6528 @cindex show all user variables
6529 @item show convenience
6530 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6531 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6532
6533 @kindex init-if-undefined
6534 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6535 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6536 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6537 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6538 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6539 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6540 override default values used in a command script.
6541
6542 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6543 any side-effects do not occur.
6544 @end table
6545
6546 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6547 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6548 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6549
6550 @smallexample
6551 set $i = 0
6552 print bar[$i++]->contents
6553 @end smallexample
6554
6555 @noindent
6556 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6557
6558 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6559 values likely to be useful.
6560
6561 @table @code
6562 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6563 @item $_
6564 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6565 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6566 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6567 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6568 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6569 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6570 to the type of @code{$__}.
6571
6572 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6573 @item $__
6574 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6575 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6576 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6577
6578 @item $_exitcode
6579 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6580 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6581 the program being debugged terminates.
6582 @end table
6583
6584 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6585 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6586 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6587
6588 @node Registers
6589 @section Registers
6590
6591 @cindex registers
6592 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6593 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6594 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6595 your machine.
6596
6597 @table @code
6598 @kindex info registers
6599 @item info registers
6600 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6601 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6602
6603 @kindex info all-registers
6604 @cindex floating point registers
6605 @item info all-registers
6606 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6607 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6608
6609 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6610 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6611 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6612 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6613 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6614 @end table
6615
6616 @cindex stack pointer register
6617 @cindex program counter register
6618 @cindex process status register
6619 @cindex frame pointer register
6620 @cindex standard registers
6621 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6622 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6623 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6624 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6625 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6626 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6627 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6628 you could print the program counter in hex with
6629
6630 @smallexample
6631 p/x $pc
6632 @end smallexample
6633
6634 @noindent
6635 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6636
6637 @smallexample
6638 x/i $pc
6639 @end smallexample
6640
6641 @noindent
6642 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6643 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6644 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6645 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6646 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6647 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6648 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6649
6650 @smallexample
6651 set $sp += 4
6652 @end smallexample
6653
6654 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6655 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6656 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6657 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6658 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6659 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6660 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6661
6662 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6663 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6664 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6665 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6666 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6667 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6668 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6669
6670 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6671 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6672 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6673 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6674 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6675 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6676 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6677 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6678 prints the data in both formats.
6679
6680 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6681 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6682 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6683 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6684 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6685 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6686 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6687
6688 @smallexample
6689 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6690 $1 = @{
6691 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6692 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6693 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6694 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6695 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6696 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6697 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6698 @}
6699 @end smallexample
6700
6701 @noindent
6702 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6703 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6704 value to a @code{struct} member:
6705
6706 @smallexample
6707 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6708 @end smallexample
6709
6710 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6711 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6712 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6713 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6714 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6715 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6716
6717 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6718 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6719 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6720 frame makes no difference.
6721
6722 @node Floating Point Hardware
6723 @section Floating Point Hardware
6724 @cindex floating point
6725
6726 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6727 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6728
6729 @table @code
6730 @kindex info float
6731 @item info float
6732 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6733 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6734 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6735 the ARM and x86 machines.
6736 @end table
6737
6738 @node Vector Unit
6739 @section Vector Unit
6740 @cindex vector unit
6741
6742 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6743 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6744
6745 @table @code
6746 @kindex info vector
6747 @item info vector
6748 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6749 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6750 @end table
6751
6752 @node OS Information
6753 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6754 @cindex OS information
6755
6756 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6757 you debug your program.
6758
6759 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6760 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6761 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6762 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6763 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6764 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6765 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6766 structure.
6767
6768 @table @code
6769 @item info udot
6770 @kindex info udot
6771 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6772 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6773 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6774 the @code{examine} command.
6775 @end table
6776
6777 @cindex auxiliary vector
6778 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6779 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6780 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6781 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6782 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6783 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6784 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6785 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6786 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6787 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6788 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6789 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6790
6791 @table @code
6792 @kindex info auxv
6793 @item info auxv
6794 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6795 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6796 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6797 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6798 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6799 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6800 an unrecognized tag.
6801 @end table
6802
6803
6804 @node Memory Region Attributes
6805 @section Memory Region Attributes
6806 @cindex memory region attributes
6807
6808 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6809 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6810 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6811 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6812 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6813 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6814 user can override the fetched regions.
6815
6816 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6817 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6818 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6819 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6820 all memory.
6821
6822 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6823 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6824
6825 @table @code
6826 @kindex mem
6827 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6828 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6829 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6830 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6831 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
6832 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6833
6834 @item mem auto
6835 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6836 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6837
6838 @kindex delete mem
6839 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6840 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6841 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6842
6843 @kindex disable mem
6844 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6845 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6846 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6847 It may be enabled again later.
6848
6849 @kindex enable mem
6850 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6851 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6852
6853 @kindex info mem
6854 @item info mem
6855 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6856 for each region:
6857
6858 @table @emph
6859 @item Memory Region Number
6860 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6861 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6862 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6863
6864 @item Lo Address
6865 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6866
6867 @item Hi Address
6868 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6869
6870 @item Attributes
6871 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6872 @end table
6873 @end table
6874
6875
6876 @subsection Attributes
6877
6878 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6879 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6880 write accesses to a memory region.
6881
6882 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6883 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6884 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6885
6886 @table @code
6887 @item ro
6888 Memory is read only.
6889 @item wo
6890 Memory is write only.
6891 @item rw
6892 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6893 @end table
6894
6895 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6896 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6897 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6898 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6899 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6900
6901 @table @code
6902 @item 8
6903 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6904 @item 16
6905 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6906 @item 32
6907 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6908 @item 64
6909 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6910 @end table
6911
6912 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6913 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6914 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6915 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6916 @c
6917 @c @table @code
6918 @c @item hwbreak
6919 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6920 @c @item swbreak (default)
6921 @c @end table
6922
6923 @subsubsection Data Cache
6924 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6925 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6926 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6927 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6928 registers.
6929
6930 @table @code
6931 @item cache
6932 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6933 @item nocache
6934 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6935 @end table
6936
6937 @subsection Memory Access Checking
6938 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
6939 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
6940 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
6941 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
6942
6943 @table @code
6944 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
6945 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
6946 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
6947 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
6948 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
6949 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
6950 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
6951 The default value is @code{off}.
6952 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
6953 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
6954 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
6955 @end table
6956
6957
6958 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6959 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6960 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6961 @c
6962 @c @table @code
6963 @c @item verify
6964 @c @item noverify (default)
6965 @c @end table
6966
6967 @node Dump/Restore Files
6968 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
6969 @cindex dump/restore files
6970 @cindex append data to a file
6971 @cindex dump data to a file
6972 @cindex restore data from a file
6973
6974 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6975 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6976 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6977 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6978 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6979 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6980 files.
6981
6982 @table @code
6983
6984 @kindex dump
6985 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6986 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6987 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6988 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6989
6990 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6991 @table @code
6992 @item binary
6993 Raw binary form.
6994 @item ihex
6995 Intel hex format.
6996 @item srec
6997 Motorola S-record format.
6998 @item tekhex
6999 Tektronix Hex format.
7000 @end table
7001
7002 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7003 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7004 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7005 form.
7006
7007 @kindex append
7008 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7009 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7010 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7011 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7012 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7013
7014 @kindex restore
7015 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7016 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7017 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7018 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7019 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7020
7021 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7022 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7023 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7024 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7025 from that location.
7026
7027 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7028 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7029 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7030 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7031
7032 @end table
7033
7034 @node Core File Generation
7035 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7036 @cindex dump core from inferior
7037
7038 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7039 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7040 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7041 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7042 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7043 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7044 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7045
7046 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7047 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7048 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7049
7050 @table @code
7051 @kindex gcore
7052 @kindex generate-core-file
7053 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7054 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7055 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7056 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7057 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7058 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7059
7060 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7061 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7062 @end table
7063
7064 @node Character Sets
7065 @section Character Sets
7066 @cindex character sets
7067 @cindex charset
7068 @cindex translating between character sets
7069 @cindex host character set
7070 @cindex target character set
7071
7072 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7073 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7074 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7075 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7076 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7077 @dfn{target character set}.
7078
7079 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7080 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7081 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7082 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7083 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7084 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7085 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7086 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7087 character and string literals in expressions.
7088
7089 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7090 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7091 target-charset} command, described below.
7092
7093 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7094 support:
7095
7096 @table @code
7097 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7098 @kindex set target-charset
7099 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7100 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7101 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7102 list the target character sets it supports.
7103 @end table
7104
7105 @table @code
7106 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7107 @kindex set host-charset
7108 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7109
7110 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7111 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7112 @code{set host-charset} command.
7113
7114 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7115 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7116 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7117 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7118 list the host character sets it supports.
7119
7120 @item set charset @var{charset}
7121 @kindex set charset
7122 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7123 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7124 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7125 for both host and target.
7126
7127
7128 @item show charset
7129 @kindex show charset
7130 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7131
7132 @itemx show host-charset
7133 @kindex show host-charset
7134 Show the name of the current host charset.
7135
7136 @itemx show target-charset
7137 @kindex show target-charset
7138 Show the name of the current target charset.
7139
7140 @end table
7141
7142 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7143 sets:
7144
7145 @table @code
7146
7147 @item ASCII
7148 @cindex ASCII character set
7149 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7150 character set.
7151
7152 @item ISO-8859-1
7153 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7154 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7155 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7156 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7157 this as its host character set.
7158
7159 @item EBCDIC-US
7160 @itemx IBM1047
7161 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7162 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7163 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7164 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7165 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7166
7167 @end table
7168
7169 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7170 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7171 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7172
7173 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7174 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7175 @file{charset-test.c}:
7176
7177 @smallexample
7178 #include <stdio.h>
7179
7180 char ascii_hello[]
7181 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7182 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7183 char ibm1047_hello[]
7184 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7185 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7186
7187 main ()
7188 @{
7189 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7190 @}
7191 @end smallexample
7192
7193 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7194 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7195 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7196
7197 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7198
7199 @smallexample
7200 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7201 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7202 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7203 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7204 @dots{}
7205 (@value{GDBP})
7206 @end smallexample
7207
7208 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7209 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7210 strings:
7211
7212 @smallexample
7213 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7214 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7215 (@value{GDBP})
7216 @end smallexample
7217
7218 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7219 initial character set:
7220 @smallexample
7221 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7222 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7223 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7224 (@value{GDBP})
7225 @end smallexample
7226
7227 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7228 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7229 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7230 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7231 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7232
7233 @smallexample
7234 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7235 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7236 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7237 $2 = 72 'H'
7238 (@value{GDBP})
7239 @end smallexample
7240
7241 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7242 literals you use in expressions:
7243
7244 @smallexample
7245 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7246 $3 = 43 '+'
7247 (@value{GDBP})
7248 @end smallexample
7249
7250 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7251 character.
7252
7253 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7254 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7255 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7256
7257 @smallexample
7258 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7259 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7260 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7261 $5 = 200 '\310'
7262 (@value{GDBP})
7263 @end smallexample
7264
7265 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7266 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7267
7268 @smallexample
7269 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7270 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7271 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7272 @end smallexample
7273
7274 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7275 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7276 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7277 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7278 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7279
7280 @smallexample
7281 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7282 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7283 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7284 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7285 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7286 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7287 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7288 $7 = 72 '\110'
7289 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7290 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7291 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7292 $9 = 200 'H'
7293 (@value{GDBP})
7294 @end smallexample
7295
7296 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7297 string literals you use in expressions:
7298
7299 @smallexample
7300 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7301 $10 = 78 '+'
7302 (@value{GDBP})
7303 @end smallexample
7304
7305 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7306 character.
7307
7308 @node Caching Remote Data
7309 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7310 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7311
7312 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7313 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7314 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7315 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7316 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7317 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7318 volatile registers are in use.
7319
7320 @table @code
7321 @kindex set remotecache
7322 @item set remotecache on
7323 @itemx set remotecache off
7324 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7325 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7326
7327 @kindex show remotecache
7328 @item show remotecache
7329 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7330
7331 @kindex info dcache
7332 @item info dcache
7333 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7334 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7335 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7336 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7337 the data cache operation.
7338 @end table
7339
7340
7341 @node Macros
7342 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7343
7344 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7345 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7346 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7347 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7348 where it was defined.
7349
7350 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7351 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7352 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7353 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7354
7355 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7356 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7357 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7358 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7359 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7360 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7361 see @ref{List}.
7362
7363 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7364 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7365 variable-arity macros.
7366
7367 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7368 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7369 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7370
7371 @table @code
7372
7373 @kindex macro expand
7374 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7375 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7376 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7377 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7378 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7379 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7380 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7381 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7382 it can be any string of tokens.
7383
7384 @kindex macro exp1
7385 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7386 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7387 @cindex expand macro once
7388 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7389 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7390 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7391 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7392 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7393 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7394 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7395 can be any string of tokens.
7396
7397 @kindex info macro
7398 @cindex macro definition, showing
7399 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7400 @item info macro @var{macro}
7401 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7402 source location where that definition was established.
7403
7404 @kindex macro define
7405 @cindex user-defined macros
7406 @cindex defining macros interactively
7407 @cindex macros, user-defined
7408 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7409 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7410 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7411 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7412 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7413 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7414 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7415 given in @var{arglist}.
7416
7417 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7418 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7419 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7420 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7421 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7422
7423 @kindex macro undef
7424 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7425 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7426 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7427 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7428 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7429 debugged.
7430
7431 @kindex macro list
7432 @item macro list
7433 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7434 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7435 @end table
7436
7437 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7438 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7439 show our source files:
7440
7441 @smallexample
7442 $ cat sample.c
7443 #include <stdio.h>
7444 #include "sample.h"
7445
7446 #define M 42
7447 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7448
7449 main ()
7450 @{
7451 #define N 28
7452 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7453 #undef N
7454 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7455 #define N 1729
7456 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7457 @}
7458 $ cat sample.h
7459 #define Q <
7460 $
7461 @end smallexample
7462
7463 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7464 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7465 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7466 information.
7467
7468 @smallexample
7469 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7470 $
7471 @end smallexample
7472
7473 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7474
7475 @smallexample
7476 $ gdb -nw sample
7477 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7478 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7479 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7480 (@value{GDBP})
7481 @end smallexample
7482
7483 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7484 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7485 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7486
7487 @smallexample
7488 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7489 3
7490 4 #define M 42
7491 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7492 6
7493 7 main ()
7494 8 @{
7495 9 #define N 28
7496 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7497 11 #undef N
7498 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7499 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7500 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7501 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7502 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7503 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7504 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7505 #define Q <
7506 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7507 expands to: (42 + 1)
7508 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7509 expands to: once (M + 1)
7510 (@value{GDBP})
7511 @end smallexample
7512
7513 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7514 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7515 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7516 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7517
7518 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7519 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7520
7521 @smallexample
7522 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7523 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7524 (@value{GDBP}) run
7525 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7526
7527 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7528 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7529 (@value{GDBP})
7530 @end smallexample
7531
7532 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7533
7534 @smallexample
7535 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7536 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7537 #define N 28
7538 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7539 expands to: 28 < 42
7540 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7541 $1 = 1
7542 (@value{GDBP})
7543 @end smallexample
7544
7545 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7546 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7547 thereof) in force at each point:
7548
7549 @smallexample
7550 (@value{GDBP}) next
7551 Hello, world!
7552 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7553 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7554 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7555 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7556 (@value{GDBP}) next
7557 We're so creative.
7558 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7559 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7560 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7561 #define N 1729
7562 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7563 expands to: 1729 < 42
7564 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7565 $2 = 0
7566 (@value{GDBP})
7567 @end smallexample
7568
7569
7570 @node Tracepoints
7571 @chapter Tracepoints
7572 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7573 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7574
7575 @cindex tracepoints
7576 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7577 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7578 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7579 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7580 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7581 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7582 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7583
7584 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7585 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7586 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7587 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7588 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7589 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7590 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7591 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7592 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7593 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7594 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7595
7596 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7597 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7598 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7599 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7600 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7601 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7602 Packets}.
7603
7604 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7605
7606 @menu
7607 * Set Tracepoints::
7608 * Analyze Collected Data::
7609 * Tracepoint Variables::
7610 @end menu
7611
7612 @node Set Tracepoints
7613 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7614
7615 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7616 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7617 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7618 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7619 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7620 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7621 work on.
7622
7623 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7624 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7625 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7626 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7627 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7628 tracepoint was hit.
7629
7630 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7631 conditions and actions.
7632
7633 @menu
7634 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7635 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7636 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7637 * Tracepoint Actions::
7638 * Listing Tracepoints::
7639 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7640 @end menu
7641
7642 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7643 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7644
7645 @table @code
7646 @cindex set tracepoint
7647 @kindex trace
7648 @item trace
7649 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7650 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7651 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7652 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7653 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7654 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7655 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7656 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7657 running.
7658
7659 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7660
7661 @smallexample
7662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7663
7664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7665
7666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7667
7668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7669
7670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7671 @end smallexample
7672
7673 @noindent
7674 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7675
7676 @vindex $tpnum
7677 @cindex last tracepoint number
7678 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7679 @cindex tracepoint number
7680 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7681 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7682
7683 @kindex delete tracepoint
7684 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7685 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7686 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7687 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7688
7689 Examples:
7690
7691 @smallexample
7692 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7693
7694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7695 @end smallexample
7696
7697 @noindent
7698 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7699 @end table
7700
7701 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7702 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7703
7704 @table @code
7705 @kindex disable tracepoint
7706 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7707 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7708 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7709 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7710 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7711
7712 @kindex enable tracepoint
7713 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7714 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7715 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7716 run.
7717 @end table
7718
7719 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7720 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7721
7722 @table @code
7723 @kindex passcount
7724 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7725 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7726 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7727 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7728 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7729 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7730 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7731 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7732 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7733 user.
7734
7735 Examples:
7736
7737 @smallexample
7738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7739 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7740
7741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7742 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7749 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7750 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7751 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7752 @end smallexample
7753 @end table
7754
7755 @node Tracepoint Actions
7756 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7757
7758 @table @code
7759 @kindex actions
7760 @cindex tracepoint actions
7761 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7762 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7763 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7764 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7765 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7766 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7767 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7768 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7769 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7770 @code{while-stepping}.
7771
7772 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7773 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7774 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7775
7776 @smallexample
7777 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7778
7779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7780
7781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7782 @end smallexample
7783
7784 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7785 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7786 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7787 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7788 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7789 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7790 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7791 @code{end} command.
7792
7793 @smallexample
7794 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7795 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7796 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7797 > collect bar,baz
7798 > collect $regs
7799 > while-stepping 12
7800 > collect $fp, $sp
7801 > end
7802 end
7803 @end smallexample
7804
7805 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7806 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7807 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7808 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7809 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7810 special arguments are supported:
7811
7812 @table @code
7813 @item $regs
7814 collect all registers
7815
7816 @item $args
7817 collect all function arguments
7818
7819 @item $locals
7820 collect all local variables.
7821 @end table
7822
7823 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7824 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7825 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7826
7827 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7828 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7829
7830 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7831 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7832 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7833 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7834 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7835 its own @code{end} command):
7836
7837 @smallexample
7838 > while-stepping 12
7839 > collect $regs, myglobal
7840 > end
7841 >
7842 @end smallexample
7843
7844 @noindent
7845 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7846 @code{stepping}.
7847 @end table
7848
7849 @node Listing Tracepoints
7850 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7851
7852 @table @code
7853 @kindex info tracepoints
7854 @kindex info tp
7855 @cindex information about tracepoints
7856 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7857 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7858 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7859 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7860 shown:
7861
7862 @itemize @bullet
7863 @item
7864 its number
7865 @item
7866 whether it is enabled or disabled
7867 @item
7868 its address
7869 @item
7870 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7871 @item
7872 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7873 @item
7874 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7875 @item
7876 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7877 @end itemize
7878
7879 @smallexample
7880 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7881 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7882 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7883 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7884 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7885 (@value{GDBP})
7886 @end smallexample
7887
7888 @noindent
7889 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7890 @end table
7891
7892 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7893 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7894
7895 @table @code
7896 @kindex tstart
7897 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7898 @cindex collected data discarded
7899 @item tstart
7900 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7901 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7902 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7903 experiment.
7904
7905 @kindex tstop
7906 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7907 @item tstop
7908 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7909 stops collecting data.
7910
7911 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7912 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7913 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7914
7915 @kindex tstatus
7916 @cindex status of trace data collection
7917 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7918 @item tstatus
7919 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7920 collection.
7921 @end table
7922
7923 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7924
7925 @smallexample
7926 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7927 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7928 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7929 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7930 > while-stepping 11
7931 > collect $regs
7932 > end
7933 > end
7934 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7935 [time passes @dots{}]
7936 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7937 @end smallexample
7938
7939
7940 @node Analyze Collected Data
7941 @section Using the Collected Data
7942
7943 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7944 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7945 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7946 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7947 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7948 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7949 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7950 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7951 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7952 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7953 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7954 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7955 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7956 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7957 the buffer will fail.
7958
7959 @menu
7960 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7961 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7962 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7963 @end menu
7964
7965 @node tfind
7966 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7967
7968 @kindex tfind
7969 @cindex select trace snapshot
7970 @cindex find trace snapshot
7971 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7972 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7973 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7974 snapshot is selected.
7975
7976 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7977
7978 @table @code
7979 @item tfind start
7980 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7981 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7982
7983 @item tfind none
7984 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7985
7986 @item tfind end
7987 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7988
7989 @item tfind
7990 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7991
7992 @item tfind -
7993 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7994 retracing earlier steps.
7995
7996 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7997 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7998 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7999 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8000 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8001
8002 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8003 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8004 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8005 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8006 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8007
8008 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8009 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8010 addresses.
8011
8012 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8013 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8014 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8015
8016 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8017 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8018 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8019 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8020 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8021 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8022 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8023 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8024 @end table
8025
8026 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8027 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8028 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8029 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8030 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8031 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8032 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8033 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8034 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8035 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8036 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8037 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8038 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8039 tracepoint as the current one.
8040
8041 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8042 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8043 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8044 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8045 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8046
8047 @smallexample
8048 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8050 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8051 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8052 > tfind
8053 > end
8054
8055 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8056 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8057 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8058 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8059 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8060 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8061 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8062 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8063 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8064 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8065 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8066 @end smallexample
8067
8068 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8069 the buffer:
8070
8071 @smallexample
8072 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8073 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8074 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8075 > tfind line
8076 > end
8077
8078 Frame 0, X = 1
8079 Frame 7, X = 2
8080 Frame 13, X = 255
8081 @end smallexample
8082
8083 @node tdump
8084 @subsection @code{tdump}
8085 @kindex tdump
8086 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8087 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8088
8089 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8090 the current trace snapshot.
8091
8092 @smallexample
8093 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8094 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8095 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8096 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8097 > end
8098
8099 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8100
8101 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8102 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8103 at gdb_test.c:444
8104 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8105
8106 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8107 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8108 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8109 d1 0x18 24
8110 d2 0x80 128
8111 d3 0x33 51
8112 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8113 d5 0x22 34
8114 d6 0xe0 224
8115 d7 0x380035 3670069
8116 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8117 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8118 a2 0x100 256
8119 a3 0x322000 3284992
8120 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8121 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8122 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8123 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8124 ps 0x0 0
8125 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8126 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8127 fpstatus 0x0 0
8128 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8129 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8130 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8131 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8132 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8133 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8134 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8135 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8136 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8137
8138 (@value{GDBP})
8139 @end smallexample
8140
8141 @node save-tracepoints
8142 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8143 @kindex save-tracepoints
8144 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8145
8146 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8147 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8148 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8149 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8150 Files}).
8151
8152 @node Tracepoint Variables
8153 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8154 @cindex tracepoint variables
8155 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8156
8157 @table @code
8158 @vindex $trace_frame
8159 @item (int) $trace_frame
8160 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8161 snapshot is selected.
8162
8163 @vindex $tracepoint
8164 @item (int) $tracepoint
8165 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8166
8167 @vindex $trace_line
8168 @item (int) $trace_line
8169 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8170
8171 @vindex $trace_file
8172 @item (char []) $trace_file
8173 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8174
8175 @vindex $trace_func
8176 @item (char []) $trace_func
8177 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8178 @end table
8179
8180 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8181 use @code{output} instead.
8182
8183 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8184 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8185 data.
8186
8187 @smallexample
8188 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8189
8190 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8191 > output $trace_file
8192 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8193 > tfind
8194 > end
8195 @end smallexample
8196
8197 @node Overlays
8198 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8199 @cindex overlays
8200
8201 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8202 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8203 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8204 use overlays.
8205
8206 @menu
8207 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8208 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8209 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8210 mapped by asking the inferior.
8211 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8212 @end menu
8213
8214 @node How Overlays Work
8215 @section How Overlays Work
8216 @cindex mapped overlays
8217 @cindex unmapped overlays
8218 @cindex load address, overlay's
8219 @cindex mapped address
8220 @cindex overlay area
8221
8222 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8223 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8224 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8225 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8226 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8227
8228 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8229 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8230 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8231 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8232 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8233 largest overlay as well.
8234
8235 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8236 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8237 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8238 there.
8239
8240 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8241 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8242 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8243
8244 @smallexample
8245 @group
8246 Data Instruction Larger
8247 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8248 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8249 | | | | | |
8250 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8251 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8252 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8253 | and heap | | | | | |
8254 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8255 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8256 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8257 | | | | | |
8258 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8259 address | | | | | |
8260 | overlay | <-' | | |
8261 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8262 | | <---. | | load address
8263 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8264 | | | |
8265 +-----------+ | |
8266 +-----------+
8267 | |
8268 +-----------+
8269
8270 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8271 @end group
8272 @end smallexample
8273
8274 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8275 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8276 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8277 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8278 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8279 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8280 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8281 program and the overlay area.
8282
8283 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8284 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8285 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8286 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8287 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8288 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8289 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8290
8291 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8292 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8293 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8294
8295 @itemize @bullet
8296
8297 @item
8298 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8299 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8300 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8301 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8302
8303 @item
8304 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8305 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8306 your program's performance.
8307
8308 @item
8309 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8310 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8311 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8312 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8313 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8314 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8315 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8316
8317 @item
8318 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8319 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8320 instruction and data spaces.
8321
8322 @end itemize
8323
8324 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8325 improved in many ways:
8326
8327 @itemize @bullet
8328
8329 @item
8330 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8331 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8332 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8333 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8334 area in the usual way.
8335
8336 @item
8337 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8338 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8339
8340 @item
8341 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8342 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8343 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8344 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8345 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8346 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8347 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8348
8349 @end itemize
8350
8351
8352 @node Overlay Commands
8353 @section Overlay Commands
8354
8355 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8356 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8357 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8358 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8359 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8360 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8361
8362 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8363 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8364
8365 @table @code
8366 @item overlay off
8367 @kindex overlay
8368 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8369 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8370 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8371 overlay support is disabled.
8372
8373 @item overlay manual
8374 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8375 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8376 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8377 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8378 commands described below.
8379
8380 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8381 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8382 @cindex map an overlay
8383 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8384 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8385 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8386 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8387 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8388 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8389
8390 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8391 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8392 @cindex unmap an overlay
8393 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8394 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8395 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8396 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8397
8398 @item overlay auto
8399 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8400 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8401 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8402 Overlay Debugging}.
8403
8404 @item overlay load-target
8405 @itemx overlay load
8406 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8407 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8408 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8409 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8410 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8411 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8412
8413 @item overlay list-overlays
8414 @itemx overlay list
8415 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8416 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8417 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8418
8419 @end table
8420
8421 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8422 of the function the address falls in:
8423
8424 @smallexample
8425 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8426 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8427 @end smallexample
8428 @noindent
8429 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8430 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8431 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8432 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8433
8434 @smallexample
8435 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8436 No sections are mapped.
8437 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8438 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8439 @end smallexample
8440 @noindent
8441 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8442 name normally:
8443
8444 @smallexample
8445 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8446 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8447 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8448 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8449 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8450 @end smallexample
8451
8452 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8453 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8454 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8455 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8456 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8457
8458 @itemize @bullet
8459 @item
8460 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8461 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8462 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8463 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8464 @item
8465 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8466 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8467 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8468 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8469 breakpoints properly.
8470 @end itemize
8471
8472
8473 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8474 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8475 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8476
8477 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8478 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8479 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8480 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8481 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8482 current state of the overlays.
8483
8484 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8485 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8486
8487 @table @asis
8488
8489 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8490 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8491
8492 @smallexample
8493 struct
8494 @{
8495 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8496 unsigned long vma;
8497
8498 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8499 unsigned long size;
8500
8501 /* The overlay's load address. */
8502 unsigned long lma;
8503
8504 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8505 zero otherwise. */
8506 unsigned long mapped;
8507 @}
8508 @end smallexample
8509
8510 @item @code{_novlys}:
8511 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8512 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8513
8514 @end table
8515
8516 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8517 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8518 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8519 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8520 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8521 currently mapped.
8522
8523 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8524 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8525 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8526 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8527 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8528 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8529 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8530 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8531 are not being executed.
8532
8533 @node Overlay Sample Program
8534 @section Overlay Sample Program
8535 @cindex overlay example program
8536
8537 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8538 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8539 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8540 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8541 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8542 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8543 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8544
8545 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8546 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8547 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8548 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8549
8550 @table @file
8551 @item overlays.c
8552 The main program file.
8553 @item ovlymgr.c
8554 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8555 @item foo.c
8556 @itemx bar.c
8557 @itemx baz.c
8558 @itemx grbx.c
8559 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8560 @item d10v.ld
8561 @itemx m32r.ld
8562 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8563 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8564 @end table
8565
8566 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8567 cross-compiler like this:
8568
8569 @smallexample
8570 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8571 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8572 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8573 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8574 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8575 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8576 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8577 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8578 @end smallexample
8579
8580 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8581 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8582 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8583
8584
8585 @node Languages
8586 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8587 @cindex languages
8588
8589 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8590 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8591 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8592 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8593 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8594 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8595
8596 @cindex working language
8597 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8598 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8599 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8600 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8601 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8602 language}.
8603
8604 @menu
8605 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8606 * Show:: Displaying the language
8607 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8608 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8609 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8610 @end menu
8611
8612 @node Setting
8613 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8614
8615 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8616 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8617 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8618 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8619 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8620 are printed, etc.
8621
8622 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8623 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8624 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8625 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8626 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8627 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8628 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8629 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8630 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8631 Displaying the Language}.
8632
8633 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8634 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8635 another language. In that case, make the
8636 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8637 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8638 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8639
8640 @menu
8641 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8642 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8643 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8644 @end menu
8645
8646 @node Filenames
8647 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8648
8649 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8650 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8651
8652 @table @file
8653 @item .ada
8654 @itemx .ads
8655 @itemx .adb
8656 @itemx .a
8657 Ada source file.
8658
8659 @item .c
8660 C source file
8661
8662 @item .C
8663 @itemx .cc
8664 @itemx .cp
8665 @itemx .cpp
8666 @itemx .cxx
8667 @itemx .c++
8668 C@t{++} source file
8669
8670 @item .m
8671 Objective-C source file
8672
8673 @item .f
8674 @itemx .F
8675 Fortran source file
8676
8677 @item .mod
8678 Modula-2 source file
8679
8680 @item .s
8681 @itemx .S
8682 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8683 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8684 @end table
8685
8686 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8687 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8688
8689 @node Manually
8690 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8691
8692 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8693 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8694 your program.
8695
8696 @kindex set language
8697 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8698 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8699 a language, such as
8700 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8701 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8702
8703 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8704 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8705 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8706 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8707 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8708 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8709 command such as:
8710
8711 @smallexample
8712 print a = b + c
8713 @end smallexample
8714
8715 @noindent
8716 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8717 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8718 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8719 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8720
8721 @node Automatically
8722 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8723
8724 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8725 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8726 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8727 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8728 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8729 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8730 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8731 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8732 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8733
8734 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8735 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8736 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8737 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8738 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8739
8740 @node Show
8741 @section Displaying the Language
8742
8743 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8744 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8745
8746 @table @code
8747 @item show language
8748 @kindex show language
8749 Display the current working language. This is the
8750 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8751 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8752
8753 @item info frame
8754 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8755 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8756 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8757 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8758 information listed here.
8759
8760 @item info source
8761 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8762 Display the source language of this source file.
8763 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8764 information listed here.
8765 @end table
8766
8767 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8768 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8769 with a language explicitly:
8770
8771 @table @code
8772 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8773 @kindex set extension-language
8774 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8775 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8776
8777 @item info extensions
8778 @kindex info extensions
8779 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8780 @end table
8781
8782 @node Checks
8783 @section Type and Range Checking
8784
8785 @quotation
8786 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8787 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8788 section documents the intended facilities.
8789 @end quotation
8790 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8791
8792 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8793 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8794 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8795 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8796 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8797 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8798 errors when your program is running.
8799
8800 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8801 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8802 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8803 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8804 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8805 automatically based on your program's source language.
8806 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8807 settings of supported languages.
8808
8809 @menu
8810 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8811 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8812 @end menu
8813
8814 @cindex type checking
8815 @cindex checks, type
8816 @node Type Checking
8817 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8818
8819 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8820 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8821 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8822 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8823
8824 @smallexample
8825 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8826 @exdent but
8827 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8828 @end smallexample
8829
8830 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8831 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8832
8833 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8834 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8835 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8836 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8837 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8838 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8839 also issues a warning.
8840
8841 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8842 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8843 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8844 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8845 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8846 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8847
8848 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8849 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8850 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8851 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8852 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
8853 details on specific languages.
8854
8855 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8856
8857 @kindex set check type
8858 @kindex show check type
8859 @table @code
8860 @item set check type auto
8861 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8862 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8863 each language.
8864
8865 @item set check type on
8866 @itemx set check type off
8867 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8868 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8869 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8870 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8871 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8872
8873 @item set check type warn
8874 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8875 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8876 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8877 numbers and structures.
8878
8879 @item show type
8880 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8881 is setting it automatically.
8882 @end table
8883
8884 @cindex range checking
8885 @cindex checks, range
8886 @node Range Checking
8887 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
8888
8889 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8890 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8891 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8892 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8893 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8894
8895 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8896 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8897 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8898 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8899
8900 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8901 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8902 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8903 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8904 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8905 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8906
8907 @smallexample
8908 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8909 @end smallexample
8910
8911 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8912 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
8913 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8914
8915 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8916
8917 @kindex set check range
8918 @kindex show check range
8919 @table @code
8920 @item set check range auto
8921 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8922 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8923 each language.
8924
8925 @item set check range on
8926 @itemx set check range off
8927 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8928 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8929 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8930 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8931
8932 @item set check range warn
8933 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8934 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8935 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8936 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8937 systems).
8938
8939 @item show range
8940 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8941 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8942 @end table
8943
8944 @node Supported Languages
8945 @section Supported Languages
8946
8947 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8948 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8949 @c This is false ...
8950 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8951 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8952 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8953 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8954 language.
8955
8956 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8957 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8958 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8959 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8960 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8961 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8962 language reference or tutorial.
8963
8964 @menu
8965 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8966 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8967 * Fortran:: Fortran
8968 * Pascal:: Pascal
8969 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8970 * Ada:: Ada
8971 @end menu
8972
8973 @node C
8974 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8975
8976 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8977 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8978
8979 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8980 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8981 together.
8982
8983 @cindex C@t{++}
8984 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8985 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8986 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8987 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8988 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8989 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8990 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8991
8992 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8993 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8994 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8995 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8996 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
8997 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
8998
8999 @menu
9000 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9001 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9002 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9003 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9004 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9005 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9006 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9007 @end menu
9008
9009 @node C Operators
9010 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9011
9012 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9013
9014 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9015 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9016 often defined on groups of types.
9017
9018 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9019
9020 @itemize @bullet
9021
9022 @item
9023 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9024 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9025
9026 @item
9027 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9028 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9029
9030 @item
9031 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9032
9033 @item
9034 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9035
9036 @end itemize
9037
9038 @noindent
9039 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9040 in order of increasing precedence:
9041
9042 @table @code
9043 @item ,
9044 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9045 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9046 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9047
9048 @item =
9049 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9050 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9051
9052 @item @var{op}=
9053 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9054 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9055 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9056 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9057 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9058
9059 @item ?:
9060 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9061 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9062 integral type.
9063
9064 @item ||
9065 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9066
9067 @item &&
9068 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9069
9070 @item |
9071 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9072
9073 @item ^
9074 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9075
9076 @item &
9077 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9078
9079 @item ==@r{, }!=
9080 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9081 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9082
9083 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9084 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9085 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9086 and non-zero for true.
9087
9088 @item <<@r{, }>>
9089 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9090
9091 @item @@
9092 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9093
9094 @item +@r{, }-
9095 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9096 pointer types.
9097
9098 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9099 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9100 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9101 integral types.
9102
9103 @item ++@r{, }--
9104 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9105 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9106 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9107 operation takes place.
9108
9109 @item *
9110 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9111 @code{++}.
9112
9113 @item &
9114 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9115
9116 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9117 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9118 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9119 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9120 stored.
9121
9122 @item -
9123 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9124 precedence as @code{++}.
9125
9126 @item !
9127 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9128 @code{++}.
9129
9130 @item ~
9131 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9132 @code{++}.
9133
9134
9135 @item .@r{, }->
9136 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9137 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9138 pointer based on the stored type information.
9139 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9140
9141 @item .*@r{, }->*
9142 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9143
9144 @item []
9145 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9146 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9147
9148 @item ()
9149 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9150
9151 @item ::
9152 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9153 and @code{class} types.
9154
9155 @item ::
9156 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9157 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9158 above.
9159 @end table
9160
9161 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9162 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9163 predefined meaning.
9164
9165 @node C Constants
9166 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9167
9168 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9169
9170 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9171 following ways:
9172
9173 @itemize @bullet
9174 @item
9175 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9176 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9177 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9178 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9179 @code{long} value.
9180
9181 @item
9182 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9183 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9184 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9185 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9186 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9187 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9188 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9189 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9190 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9191 constant.
9192
9193 @item
9194 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9195 integral equivalents.
9196
9197 @item
9198 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9199 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9200 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9201 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9202 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9203 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9204 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9205 @samp{\n} for newline.
9206
9207 @item
9208 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9209 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9210 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9211 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9212 characters.
9213
9214 @item
9215 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9216 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9217
9218 @item
9219 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9220 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9221 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9222 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9223 @end itemize
9224
9225 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9226 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9227
9228 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9229 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9230
9231 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9232 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9233 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9234 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9235 @quotation
9236 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9237 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9238 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9239 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9240 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9241 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9242 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9243 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9244 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9245 C@t{++} code.
9246 @end quotation
9247
9248 @enumerate
9249
9250 @cindex member functions
9251 @item
9252 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9253
9254 @smallexample
9255 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9256 @end smallexample
9257
9258 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9259 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9260 @item
9261 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9262 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9263 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9264 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9265
9266 @cindex call overloaded functions
9267 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9268 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9269 @item
9270 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9271 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9272 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9273 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9274 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9275 default arguments.
9276
9277 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9278 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9279 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9280 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9281 number of function arguments.
9282
9283 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9284 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9285 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9286
9287 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9288 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9289 @smallexample
9290 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9291 @end smallexample
9292
9293 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9294 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9295
9296 @cindex reference declarations
9297 @item
9298 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9299 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9300 dereferenced.
9301
9302 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9303 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9304 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9305 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9306 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9307
9308 @item
9309 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9310 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9311 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9312 necessary, for example in an expression like
9313 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9314 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9315 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9316 @end enumerate
9317
9318 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9319 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9320 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9321 invoking user-defined operators.
9322
9323 @node C Defaults
9324 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9325
9326 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9327
9328 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9329 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9330 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9331 selects the working language.
9332
9333 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9334 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9335 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9336 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9337 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9338 for further details.
9339
9340 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9341 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9342 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9343
9344 @node C Checks
9345 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9346
9347 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9348
9349 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9350 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9351 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9352
9353 @itemize @bullet
9354 @item
9355 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9356 enumerated tag.
9357
9358 @item
9359 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9360 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9361
9362 @ignore
9363 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9364 @c FIXME--beers?
9365 @item
9366 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9367 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9368 compilers.)
9369 @end ignore
9370 @end itemize
9371
9372 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9373 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9374 that is not itself an array.
9375
9376 @node Debugging C
9377 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9378
9379 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9380 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9381 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9382 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9383
9384 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9385 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9386 ,Expressions}.
9387
9388 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9389 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9390
9391 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9392
9393 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9394 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9395
9396 @table @code
9397 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9398 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9399 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9400 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9401 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9402
9403 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9404 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9405 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9406 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9407 classes.
9408 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9409
9410 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9411 @item catch throw
9412 @itemx catch catch
9413 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9414 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9415
9416 @cindex inheritance
9417 @item ptype @var{typename}
9418 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9419 @var{typename}.
9420 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9421
9422 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9423 @item set print demangle
9424 @itemx show print demangle
9425 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9426 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9427 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9428 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9429 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9430
9431 @item set print object
9432 @itemx show print object
9433 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9434 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9435
9436 @item set print vtbl
9437 @itemx show print vtbl
9438 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9439 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9440 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9441 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9442
9443 @kindex set overload-resolution
9444 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9445 @item set overload-resolution on
9446 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9447 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9448 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9449 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9450 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9451 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9452
9453 @item set overload-resolution off
9454 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9455 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9456 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9457 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9458 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9459 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9460 argument types.
9461
9462 @kindex show overload-resolution
9463 @item show overload-resolution
9464 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9465
9466 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9467 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9468 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9469 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9470 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9471 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9472 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9473 @end table
9474
9475 @node Objective-C
9476 @subsection Objective-C
9477
9478 @cindex Objective-C
9479 This section provides information about some commands and command
9480 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9481 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9482 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9483
9484 @menu
9485 * Method Names in Commands::
9486 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9487 @end menu
9488
9489 @node Method Names in Commands
9490 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9491
9492 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9493 names as line specifications:
9494
9495 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9496 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9497 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9498 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9499 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9500 @itemize
9501 @item @code{clear}
9502 @item @code{break}
9503 @item @code{info line}
9504 @item @code{jump}
9505 @item @code{list}
9506 @end itemize
9507
9508 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9509
9510 @smallexample
9511 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9512 @end smallexample
9513
9514 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9515 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9516 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9517 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9518 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9519 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9520 debugged, enter:
9521
9522 @smallexample
9523 break -[Fruit create]
9524 @end smallexample
9525
9526 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9527 enter:
9528
9529 @smallexample
9530 list +[NSText initialize]
9531 @end smallexample
9532
9533 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9534 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9535 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9536 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9537
9538 @smallexample
9539 break create
9540 @end smallexample
9541
9542 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9543 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9544 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9545 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9546 none apply.
9547
9548 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9549 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9550
9551 @smallexample
9552 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9553 @end smallexample
9554
9555 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9556 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9557 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9558 @kindex print-object
9559 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9560
9561 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9562
9563 @smallexample
9564 print -[@var{object} hash]
9565 @end smallexample
9566
9567 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9568 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9569 @noindent
9570 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9571 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9572 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9573 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9574 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9575 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9576
9577 @node Fortran
9578 @subsection Fortran
9579 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9580
9581 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9582 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9583
9584 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9585 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9586 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9587 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9588 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9589 underscore.
9590
9591 @menu
9592 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9593 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9594 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9595 @end menu
9596
9597 @node Fortran Operators
9598 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9599
9600 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9601
9602 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9603 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9604 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9605
9606 @table @code
9607 @item **
9608 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9609 of the second one.
9610
9611 @item :
9612 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9613 represent a section of array.
9614 @end table
9615
9616 @node Fortran Defaults
9617 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9618
9619 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9620
9621 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9622 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9623 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9624 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9625
9626 @node Special Fortran Commands
9627 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9628
9629 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9630
9631 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9632 such as displaying common blocks.
9633
9634 @table @code
9635 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9636 @kindex info common
9637 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9638 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9639 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9640 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9641 printed.
9642 @end table
9643
9644 @node Pascal
9645 @subsection Pascal
9646
9647 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9648 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9649 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9650 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9651 syntax.
9652
9653 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9654 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9655 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9656
9657 @node Modula-2
9658 @subsection Modula-2
9659
9660 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9661
9662 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9663 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9664 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9665 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9666 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9667 table.
9668
9669 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9670 @menu
9671 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9672 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9673 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9674 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9675 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9676 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9677 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9678 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9679 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9680 @end menu
9681
9682 @node M2 Operators
9683 @subsubsection Operators
9684 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9685
9686 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9687 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9688 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9689 following definitions hold:
9690
9691 @itemize @bullet
9692
9693 @item
9694 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9695 their subranges.
9696
9697 @item
9698 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9699
9700 @item
9701 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9702
9703 @item
9704 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9705 @var{type}}.
9706
9707 @item
9708 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9709
9710 @item
9711 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9712
9713 @item
9714 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9715 @end itemize
9716
9717 @noindent
9718 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9719 increasing precedence:
9720
9721 @table @code
9722 @item ,
9723 Function argument or array index separator.
9724
9725 @item :=
9726 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9727 @var{value}.
9728
9729 @item <@r{, }>
9730 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9731 types.
9732
9733 @item <=@r{, }>=
9734 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9735 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9736 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9737
9738 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9739 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9740 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9741 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9742 comment character.
9743
9744 @item IN
9745 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9746 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9747
9748 @item OR
9749 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9750
9751 @item AND@r{, }&
9752 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9753
9754 @item @@
9755 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9756
9757 @item +@r{, }-
9758 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9759 and difference on set types.
9760
9761 @item *
9762 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9763 on set types.
9764
9765 @item /
9766 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9767 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9768
9769 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9770 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9771 precedence as @code{*}.
9772
9773 @item -
9774 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9775
9776 @item ^
9777 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9778
9779 @item NOT
9780 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9781 @code{^}.
9782
9783 @item .
9784 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9785 precedence as @code{^}.
9786
9787 @item []
9788 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9789
9790 @item ()
9791 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9792 as @code{^}.
9793
9794 @item ::@r{, }.
9795 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9796 @end table
9797
9798 @quotation
9799 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9800 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9801 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9802 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9803 @end quotation
9804
9805
9806 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9807 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
9808 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9809
9810 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9811 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9812
9813 @table @var
9814
9815 @item a
9816 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9817
9818 @item c
9819 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9820
9821 @item i
9822 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9823
9824 @item m
9825 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9826 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9827 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9828
9829 @item n
9830 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9831
9832 @item r
9833 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9834
9835 @item t
9836 represents a type.
9837
9838 @item v
9839 represents a variable.
9840
9841 @item x
9842 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9843 explanation of the function for details.
9844 @end table
9845
9846 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9847
9848 @table @code
9849 @item ABS(@var{n})
9850 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9851
9852 @item CAP(@var{c})
9853 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9854 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9855
9856 @item CHR(@var{i})
9857 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9858
9859 @item DEC(@var{v})
9860 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9861
9862 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9863 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9864 new value.
9865
9866 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9867 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9868 set.
9869
9870 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9871 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9872
9873 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9874 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9875
9876 @item INC(@var{v})
9877 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9878
9879 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9880 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9881 new value.
9882
9883 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9884 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9885 there. Returns the new set.
9886
9887 @item MAX(@var{t})
9888 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9889
9890 @item MIN(@var{t})
9891 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9892
9893 @item ODD(@var{i})
9894 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9895
9896 @item ORD(@var{x})
9897 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9898 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9899 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9900 integral, character and enumerated types.
9901
9902 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9903 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9904
9905 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9906 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9907
9908 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9909 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9910 @end table
9911
9912 @quotation
9913 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9914 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9915 an error.
9916 @end quotation
9917
9918 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9919 @node M2 Constants
9920 @subsubsection Constants
9921
9922 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9923 ways:
9924
9925 @itemize @bullet
9926
9927 @item
9928 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9929 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9930 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9931 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9932
9933 @item
9934 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9935 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9936 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9937 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9938 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9939 digits.
9940
9941 @item
9942 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9943 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9944 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9945 followed by a @samp{C}.
9946
9947 @item
9948 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9949 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9950 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9951 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9952 sequences.
9953
9954 @item
9955 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9956
9957 @item
9958 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9959 @code{FALSE}.
9960
9961 @item
9962 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9963
9964 @item
9965 Set constants are not yet supported.
9966 @end itemize
9967
9968 @node M2 Types
9969 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9970 @cindex Modula-2 types
9971
9972 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9973 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9974 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9975 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9976 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9977 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9978
9979 The first example contains the following section of code:
9980
9981 @smallexample
9982 VAR
9983 s: SET OF CHAR ;
9984 r: [20..40] ;
9985 @end smallexample
9986
9987 @noindent
9988 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
9989 @code{r} and @code{s}.
9990
9991 @smallexample
9992 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9993 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
9994 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9995 SET OF CHAR
9996 (@value{GDBP}) print r
9997 21
9998 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
9999 [20..40]
10000 @end smallexample
10001
10002 @noindent
10003 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10004
10005 @smallexample
10006 VAR
10007 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10008 @end smallexample
10009
10010 @noindent
10011 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10012
10013 @smallexample
10014 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10015 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10016 @end smallexample
10017
10018 @noindent
10019 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10020 expressions using the debugger.
10021
10022 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10023 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10024
10025 @smallexample
10026 VAR
10027 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10028 @end smallexample
10029
10030 @smallexample
10031 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10032 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10033 @end smallexample
10034
10035 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10036 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10037 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10038 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
10039
10040 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10041
10042 @smallexample
10043 TYPE
10044 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10045 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10046 VAR
10047 s: t ;
10048 BEGIN
10049 s := blue ;
10050 @end smallexample
10051
10052 @noindent
10053 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10054 and value of a variable.
10055
10056 @smallexample
10057 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10058 $1 = blue
10059 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10060 type = [blue..yellow]
10061 @end smallexample
10062
10063 @noindent
10064 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10065 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10066 their @code{C} counterparts.
10067
10068 @smallexample
10069 VAR
10070 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10071 BEGIN
10072 s[1] := 1 ;
10073 @end smallexample
10074
10075 @smallexample
10076 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10077 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10078 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10079 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10080 @end smallexample
10081
10082 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10083 pointer types as shown in this example:
10084
10085 @smallexample
10086 VAR
10087 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10088 BEGIN
10089 NEW(s) ;
10090 s^[1] := 1 ;
10091 @end smallexample
10092
10093 @noindent
10094 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10095
10096 @smallexample
10097 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10098 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10099 @end smallexample
10100
10101 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10102 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10103 types:
10104
10105 @smallexample
10106 TYPE
10107 foo = RECORD
10108 f1: CARDINAL ;
10109 f2: CHAR ;
10110 f3: myarray ;
10111 END ;
10112
10113 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10114 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10115 VAR
10116 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10117 @end smallexample
10118
10119 @noindent
10120 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10121 below.
10122
10123 @smallexample
10124 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10125 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10126 f1 : CARDINAL;
10127 f2 : CHAR;
10128 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10129 END
10130 @end smallexample
10131
10132 @node M2 Defaults
10133 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10134 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10135
10136 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10137 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10138 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10139 selected the working language.
10140
10141 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10142 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10143 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10144 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10145
10146 @node Deviations
10147 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10148 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10149
10150 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10151 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10152
10153 @itemize @bullet
10154 @item
10155 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10156 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10157 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10158 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10159 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10160 returned a pointer.)
10161
10162 @item
10163 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10164 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10165 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10166 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10167
10168 @item
10169 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10170 argument.
10171
10172 @item
10173 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10174 @end itemize
10175
10176 @node M2 Checks
10177 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10178 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10179
10180 @quotation
10181 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10182 range checking.
10183 @end quotation
10184 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10185
10186 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10187
10188 @itemize @bullet
10189 @item
10190 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10191 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10192
10193 @item
10194 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10195 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10196 @end itemize
10197
10198 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10199 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10200
10201 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10202 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10203
10204 @node M2 Scope
10205 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10206 @cindex scope
10207 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10208 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10209 @ifinfo
10210 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10211 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10212 @end ifinfo
10213 @iftex
10214 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10215 @end iftex
10216
10217 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10218 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10219 similar syntax:
10220
10221 @smallexample
10222
10223 @var{module} . @var{id}
10224 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10225 @end smallexample
10226
10227 @noindent
10228 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10229 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10230 identifier within your program, except another module.
10231
10232 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10233 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10234 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10235 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10236
10237 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10238 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10239 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10240 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10241 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10242 @var{module}.
10243
10244 @node GDB/M2
10245 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10246
10247 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10248 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10249 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10250 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10251 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10252 analogue in Modula-2.
10253
10254 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10255 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10256 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10257 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10258 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10259 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10260
10261 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10262 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10263 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10264
10265 @node Ada
10266 @subsection Ada
10267 @cindex Ada
10268
10269 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10270 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10271 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10272 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10273 to be difficult.
10274
10275
10276 @cindex expressions in Ada
10277 @menu
10278 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10279 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10280 in @value{GDBN}.
10281 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10282 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10283 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10284 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10285 @end menu
10286
10287 @node Ada Mode Intro
10288 @subsubsection Introduction
10289 @cindex Ada mode, general
10290
10291 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10292 syntax, with some extensions.
10293 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10294
10295 @itemize @bullet
10296 @item
10297 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10298 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10299 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10300 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10301
10302 @item
10303 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10304 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10305
10306 @item
10307 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10308 @end itemize
10309
10310 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10311 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10312 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10313 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10314 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10315
10316 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10317 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10318 was translated from an Ada source file.
10319
10320 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10321 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10322 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10323 middle (to allow based literals).
10324
10325 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10326 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10327 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10328 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10329 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10330 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10331
10332 @node Omissions from Ada
10333 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10334 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10335
10336 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10337
10338 @itemize @bullet
10339 @item
10340 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10341
10342 @itemize @minus
10343 @item
10344 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10345 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10346
10347 @item
10348 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10349
10350 @item
10351 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10352
10353 @item
10354 @t{'Tag}.
10355
10356 @item
10357 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10358 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10359
10360 @item
10361 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10362 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10363
10364 @item
10365 @t{'Address}.
10366 @end itemize
10367
10368 @item
10369 The names in
10370 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10371 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10372 not currently available.
10373
10374 @item
10375 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10376 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10377 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10378 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10379 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10380 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10381 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10382 indeterminate values.
10383
10384 @item
10385 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10386 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10387 are not implemented.
10388
10389 @item
10390 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10391 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10392 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10393 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10394 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10395
10396 @smallexample
10397 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10398 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10399 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10400 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10401 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10402 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10403 @end smallexample
10404
10405 Changing a
10406 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10407 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10408 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10409 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10410 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10411 declared to have a type such as:
10412
10413 @smallexample
10414 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10415 Id : Integer;
10416 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10417 end record;
10418 @end smallexample
10419
10420 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10421 assignments:
10422
10423 @smallexample
10424 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10425 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10426 @end smallexample
10427
10428 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10429 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10430 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10431 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10432 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10433 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10434 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10435 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10436
10437 @item
10438 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10439
10440 @item
10441 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10442 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10443 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10444 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10445 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10446 the proper resolution.
10447
10448 @item
10449 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10450
10451 @item
10452 Entry calls are not implemented.
10453
10454 @item
10455 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10456 formats are not supported.
10457
10458 @item
10459 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10460 @end itemize
10461
10462 @node Additions to Ada
10463 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10464 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10465
10466 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10467 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10468
10469 @itemize @bullet
10470 @item
10471 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10472 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10473 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10474 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10475 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10476 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10477 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10478 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10479
10480 @item
10481 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10482 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10483 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10484
10485 @item
10486 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10487 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10488
10489 @item
10490 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10491 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10492 @end itemize
10493
10494 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10495 additions specific to Ada:
10496
10497 @itemize @bullet
10498 @item
10499 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10500 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10501
10502 @smallexample
10503 set x := y + 3
10504 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10505 @end smallexample
10506
10507 @item
10508 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10509 the value of its right-hand operand.
10510 This allows, for example,
10511 complex conditional breaks:
10512
10513 @smallexample
10514 break f
10515 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10516 @end smallexample
10517
10518 @item
10519 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10520 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10521 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10522 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10523 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10524 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10525 in strings. For example,
10526 @smallexample
10527 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10528 @end smallexample
10529 @noindent
10530 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10531 after each period.
10532
10533 @item
10534 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10535 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10536 to write
10537
10538 @smallexample
10539 print 'max(x, y)
10540 @end smallexample
10541
10542 @item
10543 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10544 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10545 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10546 of 3 might print as
10547
10548 @smallexample
10549 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10550 @end smallexample
10551
10552 @noindent
10553 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10554 clause.
10555
10556 @item
10557 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10558 multi-character subsequence of
10559 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10560 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10561 in place of @t{a'length}.
10562
10563 @item
10564 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10565 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10566 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10567 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10568 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10569 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10570 For example,
10571 @smallexample
10572 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10573 @end smallexample
10574
10575 @item
10576 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10577 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10578 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10579 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10580 object.
10581
10582 @end itemize
10583
10584 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10585 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10586
10587 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10588 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10589 before reaching the main procedure.
10590 As defined in the Ada Reference
10591 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10592 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10593 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10594 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10595
10596 @node Ada Glitches
10597 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10598 @cindex Ada, problems
10599
10600 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10601 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10602 @value{GDBN},
10603 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10604 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10605
10606 @itemize @bullet
10607 @item
10608 Currently, the debugger
10609 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10610 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10611 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10612 to get it printed properly.
10613
10614 @item
10615 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10616 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10617
10618 @item
10619 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10620 argument lists are treated as positional).
10621
10622 @item
10623 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10624
10625 @item
10626 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10627 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10628 the host machine.
10629
10630 @item
10631 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10632
10633 @item
10634 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10635 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10636 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10637 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10638 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10639 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10640 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10641 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10642 you can usually resolve the confusion
10643 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10644 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10645 @end itemize
10646
10647 @node Unsupported Languages
10648 @section Unsupported Languages
10649
10650 @cindex unsupported languages
10651 @cindex minimal language
10652 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10653 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10654 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10655 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10656 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10657 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10658
10659 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10660 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10661 language.
10662
10663 @node Symbols
10664 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10665
10666 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10667 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10668 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10669 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10670 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10671 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10672 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10673
10674 @cindex symbol names
10675 @cindex names of symbols
10676 @cindex quoting names
10677 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10678 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10679 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10680 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10681 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10682 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10683 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10684 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10685
10686 @smallexample
10687 p 'foo.c'::x
10688 @end smallexample
10689
10690 @noindent
10691 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10692
10693 @table @code
10694 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10695 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10696 @kindex set case-sensitive
10697 @item set case-sensitive on
10698 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10699 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10700 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10701 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10702 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10703 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10704 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10705 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10706 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10707 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10708 case-insensitive matches.
10709
10710 @kindex show case-sensitive
10711 @item show case-sensitive
10712 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10713 lookups.
10714
10715 @kindex info address
10716 @cindex address of a symbol
10717 @item info address @var{symbol}
10718 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10719 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10720 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10721 is always stored.
10722
10723 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10724 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10725 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10726
10727 @kindex info symbol
10728 @cindex symbol from address
10729 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10730 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10731 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10732 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10733 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10734
10735 @smallexample
10736 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10737 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10738 @end smallexample
10739
10740 @noindent
10741 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10742 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10743
10744 @kindex whatis
10745 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10746 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10747 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10748 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10749 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10750 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10751 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10752 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10753 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10754 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10755 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10756
10757 @kindex ptype
10758 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10759 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10760 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10761 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10762
10763 For example, for this variable declaration:
10764
10765 @smallexample
10766 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10767 @end smallexample
10768
10769 @noindent
10770 the two commands give this output:
10771
10772 @smallexample
10773 @group
10774 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10775 type = struct complex
10776 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10777 type = struct complex @{
10778 double real;
10779 double imag;
10780 @}
10781 @end group
10782 @end smallexample
10783
10784 @noindent
10785 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10786 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10787
10788 @cindex incomplete type
10789 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10790 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10791 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10792 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10793 given these declarations:
10794
10795 @smallexample
10796 struct foo;
10797 struct foo *fooptr;
10798 @end smallexample
10799
10800 @noindent
10801 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10802
10803 @smallexample
10804 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10805 $1 = <incomplete type>
10806 @end smallexample
10807
10808 @noindent
10809 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10810 completely specified.
10811
10812 @kindex info types
10813 @item info types @var{regexp}
10814 @itemx info types
10815 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10816 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10817 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10818 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10819 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10820 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10821 name is @code{value}.
10822
10823 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10824 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10825 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10826
10827 @kindex info scope
10828 @cindex local variables
10829 @item info scope @var{location}
10830 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10831 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10832 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10833 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10834
10835 @smallexample
10836 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10837 Scope for command_line_handler:
10838 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10839 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10840 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10841 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10842 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10843 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10844 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10845 @end smallexample
10846
10847 @noindent
10848 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10849 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10850 collect}.
10851
10852 @kindex info source
10853 @item info source
10854 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10855 the function containing the current point of execution:
10856 @itemize @bullet
10857 @item
10858 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10859 @item
10860 the directory it was compiled in,
10861 @item
10862 its length, in lines,
10863 @item
10864 which programming language it is written in,
10865 @item
10866 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10867 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10868 @item
10869 whether the debugging information includes information about
10870 preprocessor macros.
10871 @end itemize
10872
10873
10874 @kindex info sources
10875 @item info sources
10876 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10877 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10878 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10879
10880 @kindex info functions
10881 @item info functions
10882 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10883
10884 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10885 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10886 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10887 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10888 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10889 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10890 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10891 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10892
10893 @kindex info variables
10894 @item info variables
10895 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10896 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10897
10898 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10899 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10900 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10901 @var{regexp}.
10902
10903 @kindex info classes
10904 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10905 @item info classes
10906 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10907 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10908 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10909 expression.
10910
10911 @kindex info selectors
10912 @item info selectors
10913 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10914 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10915 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10916 expression.
10917
10918 @ignore
10919 This was never implemented.
10920 @kindex info methods
10921 @item info methods
10922 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10923 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10924 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10925 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10926 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10927 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10928 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10929 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10930 @end ignore
10931
10932 @cindex reloading symbols
10933 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10934 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10935 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10936 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10937 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10938
10939 @table @code
10940 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10941 @item set symbol-reloading on
10942 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10943 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10944
10945 @item set symbol-reloading off
10946 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10947 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10948 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10949 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10950 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10951 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10952 name.
10953
10954 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10955 @item show symbol-reloading
10956 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10957 @end table
10958
10959 @cindex opaque data types
10960 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10961 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10962 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10963 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10964 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10965 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10966 another source file. The default is on.
10967
10968 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10969 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10970
10971 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10972 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10973 is printed as follows:
10974 @smallexample
10975 @{<no data fields>@}
10976 @end smallexample
10977
10978 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10979 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10980 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10981
10982 @kindex maint print symbols
10983 @cindex symbol dump
10984 @kindex maint print psymbols
10985 @cindex partial symbol dump
10986 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10987 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10988 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10989 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10990 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10991 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10992 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10993 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10994 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10995 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10996 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10997 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10998 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10999 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11000 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11001 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11002 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11003
11004 @kindex maint info symtabs
11005 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11006 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11007 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11008 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11009 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11010 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11011 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11012
11013 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11014 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11015 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11016 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11017 structure in more detail. For example:
11018
11019 @smallexample
11020 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11021 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11022 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11023 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11024 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11025 readin no
11026 fullname (null)
11027 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11028 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11029 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11030 dependencies (none)
11031 @}
11032 @}
11033 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11034 (@value{GDBP})
11035 @end smallexample
11036 @noindent
11037 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11038 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11039 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11040 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11041 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11042
11043 @smallexample
11044 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11045 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11046 line 1574.
11047 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11048 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11049 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11050 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11051 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11052 dirname (null)
11053 fullname (null)
11054 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11055 debugformat DWARF 2
11056 @}
11057 @}
11058 (@value{GDBP})
11059 @end smallexample
11060 @end table
11061
11062
11063 @node Altering
11064 @chapter Altering Execution
11065
11066 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11067 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11068 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11069 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11070 program.
11071
11072 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11073 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11074 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11075
11076 @menu
11077 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11078 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11079 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11080 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11081 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11082 * Patching:: Patching your program
11083 @end menu
11084
11085 @node Assignment
11086 @section Assignment to Variables
11087
11088 @cindex assignment
11089 @cindex setting variables
11090 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11091 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11092
11093 @smallexample
11094 print x=4
11095 @end smallexample
11096
11097 @noindent
11098 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11099 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11100 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11101 information on operators in supported languages.
11102
11103 @kindex set variable
11104 @cindex variables, setting
11105 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11106 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11107 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11108 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11109 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11110
11111 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11112 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11113 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11114 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11115 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11116 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11117 command @code{set width}:
11118
11119 @smallexample
11120 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11121 type = double
11122 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11123 $4 = 13
11124 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11125 Invalid syntax in expression.
11126 @end smallexample
11127
11128 @noindent
11129 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11130 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11131
11132 @smallexample
11133 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11134 @end smallexample
11135
11136 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11137 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11138 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11139 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11140 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11141 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11142
11143 @smallexample
11144 @group
11145 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11146 type = double
11147 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11148 $1 = 1
11149 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11150 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11151 $2 = 1
11152 (@value{GDBP}) r
11153 The program being debugged has been started already.
11154 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11155 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11156 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11157 Invalid bfd target.
11158 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11159 The current BFD target is "=4".
11160 @end group
11161 @end smallexample
11162
11163 @noindent
11164 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11165 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11166 @code{g}, use
11167
11168 @smallexample
11169 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11170 @end smallexample
11171
11172 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11173 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11174 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11175 same length or shorter.
11176 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11177 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11178
11179 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11180 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11181 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11182 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11183 and representation in memory), and
11184
11185 @smallexample
11186 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11187 @end smallexample
11188
11189 @noindent
11190 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11191
11192 @node Jumping
11193 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11194
11195 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11196 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11197 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11198
11199 @table @code
11200 @kindex jump
11201 @item jump @var{linespec}
11202 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11203 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11204 Source Lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11205 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11206 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11207 Breakpoints}.
11208
11209 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11210 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11211 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11212 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11213 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11214 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11215 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11216 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11217 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11218
11219 @item jump *@var{address}
11220 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11221 @end table
11222
11223 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11224 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11225 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11226 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11227 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11228 example,
11229
11230 @smallexample
11231 set $pc = 0x485
11232 @end smallexample
11233
11234 @noindent
11235 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11236 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11237 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11238
11239 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11240 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11241 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11242 detail.
11243
11244 @c @group
11245 @node Signaling
11246 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11247 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11248
11249 @table @code
11250 @kindex signal
11251 @item signal @var{signal}
11252 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11253 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11254 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11255 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11256
11257 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11258 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11259 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11260 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11261 signal.
11262
11263 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11264 after executing the command.
11265 @end table
11266 @c @end group
11267
11268 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11269 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11270 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11271 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11272 passes the signal directly to your program.
11273
11274
11275 @node Returning
11276 @section Returning from a Function
11277
11278 @table @code
11279 @cindex returning from a function
11280 @kindex return
11281 @item return
11282 @itemx return @var{expression}
11283 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11284 command. If you give an
11285 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11286 value.
11287 @end table
11288
11289 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11290 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11291 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11292 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11293
11294 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11295 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11296 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11297 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11298 of functions.
11299
11300 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11301 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11302 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11303 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11304 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11305
11306 @node Calling
11307 @section Calling Program Functions
11308
11309 @table @code
11310 @cindex calling functions
11311 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11312 @item print @var{expr}
11313 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11314 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11315 debugged.
11316
11317 @kindex call
11318 @item call @var{expr}
11319 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11320 returned values.
11321
11322 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11323 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11324 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11325 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11326 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11327 value history.
11328 @end table
11329
11330 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11331 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11332 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11333 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11334
11335 @table @code
11336 @item set unwindonsignal
11337 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11338 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11339 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11340 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11341 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11342 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11343 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11344 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11345 received.
11346
11347 @item show unwindonsignal
11348 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11349 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11350 @value{GDBN}.
11351 @end table
11352
11353 @cindex weak alias functions
11354 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11355 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11356 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11357 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11358 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11359 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11360 function instead.
11361
11362 @node Patching
11363 @section Patching Programs
11364
11365 @cindex patching binaries
11366 @cindex writing into executables
11367 @cindex writing into corefiles
11368
11369 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11370 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11371 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11372 patching your program's binary.
11373
11374 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11375 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11376 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11377 repairs.
11378
11379 @table @code
11380 @kindex set write
11381 @item set write on
11382 @itemx set write off
11383 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11384 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11385 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11386
11387 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11388 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11389 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11390
11391 @item show write
11392 @kindex show write
11393 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11394 as well as reading.
11395 @end table
11396
11397 @node GDB Files
11398 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11399
11400 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11401 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11402 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11403 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11404
11405 @menu
11406 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11407 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11408 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11409 @end menu
11410
11411 @node Files
11412 @section Commands to Specify Files
11413
11414 @cindex symbol table
11415 @cindex core dump file
11416
11417 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11418 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11419 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11420 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11421
11422 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11423 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11424 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11425 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11426 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11427 new files are useful.
11428
11429 @table @code
11430 @cindex executable file
11431 @kindex file
11432 @item file @var{filename}
11433 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11434 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11435 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11436 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11437 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11438 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11439 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11440 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11441
11442 @cindex unlinked object files
11443 @cindex patching object files
11444 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11445 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11446 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11447 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11448 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11449 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11450 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11451 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11452
11453 @item file
11454 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11455 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11456
11457 @kindex exec-file
11458 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11459 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11460 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11461 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11462 discard information on the executable file.
11463
11464 @kindex symbol-file
11465 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11466 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11467 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11468 table and program to run from the same file.
11469
11470 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11471 program's symbol table.
11472
11473 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11474 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11475 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11476 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11477 @value{GDBN}.
11478
11479 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11480 executing it once.
11481
11482 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11483 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11484 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11485 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11486 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11487 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11488 optimized code.
11489
11490 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11491 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11492 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11493 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11494 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11495
11496 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11497 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11498 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11499 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11500 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11501 Warnings and Messages}.)
11502
11503 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11504 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11505 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11506 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11507 in stabs format.
11508
11509 @kindex readnow
11510 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11511 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11512 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11513 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11514 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11515 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11516 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11517 entire symbol table available.
11518
11519 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11520 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11521 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11522 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11523 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11524 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11525 @c files.
11526
11527 @kindex core-file
11528 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11529 @itemx core
11530 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11531 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11532 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11533 executable file itself for other parts.
11534
11535 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11536 to be used.
11537
11538 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11539 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11540 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11541 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11542 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11543
11544 @kindex add-symbol-file
11545 @cindex dynamic linking
11546 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11547 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11548 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11549 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11550 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11551 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11552 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11553 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11554 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11555 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11556 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11557 @var{address} as an expression.
11558
11559 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11560 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11561 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11562 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11563 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11564
11565 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11566 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11567 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11568 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11569 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11570 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11571 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11572 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11573 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11574
11575 @itemize @bullet
11576 @item
11577 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11578 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11579 @item
11580 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11581 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11582 @item
11583 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11584 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11585 @end itemize
11586
11587 @noindent
11588 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11589 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11590 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11591 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11592 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11593 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11594 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11595 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11596 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11597 way.
11598
11599 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11600
11601 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11602 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11603 @cindex load symbols from memory
11604 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11605 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11606 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11607 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11608 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11609 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11610 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11611 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11612 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11613
11614 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11615 @kindex assf
11616 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11617 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11618 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11619 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11620 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11621 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11622 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11623 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11624 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11625 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11626
11627 @kindex section
11628 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11629 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11630 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11631 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11632 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11633 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11634 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11635 their addresses.
11636
11637 @kindex info files
11638 @kindex info target
11639 @item info files
11640 @itemx info target
11641 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11642 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11643 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11644 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11645 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11646 current ones.
11647
11648 @kindex maint info sections
11649 @item maint info sections
11650 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11651 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11652 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11653 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11654 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11655 may be arbitrarily combined):
11656
11657 @table @code
11658 @item ALLOBJ
11659 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11660 @item @var{sections}
11661 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11662 @item @var{section-flags}
11663 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11664 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11665 @table @code
11666 @item ALLOC
11667 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11668 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11669 @item LOAD
11670 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11671 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11672 @item RELOC
11673 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11674 @item READONLY
11675 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11676 @item CODE
11677 Section contains executable code only.
11678 @item DATA
11679 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11680 @item ROM
11681 Section will reside in ROM.
11682 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11683 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11684 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11685 Section is not empty.
11686 @item NEVER_LOAD
11687 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11688 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11689 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11690 COFF shared library information.
11691 @item IS_COMMON
11692 Section contains common symbols.
11693 @end table
11694 @end table
11695 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11696 @cindex read-only sections
11697 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11698 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11699 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11700 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11701 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11702 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11703 enhancement to debugging performance.
11704
11705 The default is off.
11706
11707 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11708 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11709 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11710 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11711
11712 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11713 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11714 @end table
11715
11716 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11717 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11718 name and remembers it that way.
11719
11720 @cindex shared libraries
11721 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11722 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11723
11724 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11725 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11726 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11727 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11728 debugging a core file).
11729
11730 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11731 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11732
11733 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11734 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11735 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11736
11737 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11738 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11739 particularly large or there are many of them.
11740
11741 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11742 commands:
11743
11744 @table @code
11745 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11746 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11747 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11748 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11749 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11750 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11751 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11752 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11753
11754 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11755 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11756 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11757 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11758 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11759 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11760 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11761 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11762 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11763
11764 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11765 @item show auto-solib-add
11766 Display the current autoloading mode.
11767 @end table
11768
11769 @cindex load shared library
11770 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11771 command:
11772
11773 @table @code
11774 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11775 @kindex info share
11776 @item info share
11777 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11778 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11779
11780 @kindex sharedlibrary
11781 @kindex share
11782 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11783 @itemx share @var{regex}
11784 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11785 Unix regular expression.
11786 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11787 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11788 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11789 loaded.
11790
11791 @item nosharedlibrary
11792 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11793 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11794 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11795 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11796 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11797 discarded.
11798 @end table
11799
11800 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11801 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11802 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11803
11804 @table @code
11805 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11806 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11807 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11808 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11809 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11810 shared library.
11811
11812 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11813 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11814 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11815 library events happen.
11816 @end table
11817
11818 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11819 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11820 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11821 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11822 not.
11823
11824 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11825 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11826 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11827 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11828 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11829
11830 @table @code
11831 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11832 @cindex system root, alternate
11833 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11834 @kindex set sysroot
11835 @item set sysroot @var{path}
11836 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
11837 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
11838 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
11839 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
11840 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
11841 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
11842 under @var{path}.
11843
11844 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
11845 sysroot}.
11846
11847 @cindex default system root
11848 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11849 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
11850 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
11851 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
11852 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
11853 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
11854 location.
11855
11856 @kindex show sysroot
11857 @item show sysroot
11858 Display the current shared library prefix.
11859
11860 @kindex set solib-search-path
11861 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11862 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
11863 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
11864 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
11865 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
11866 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
11867 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
11868 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
11869 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
11870 of shared library symbols.
11871
11872 @kindex show solib-search-path
11873 @item show solib-search-path
11874 Display the current shared library search path.
11875 @end table
11876
11877
11878 @node Separate Debug Files
11879 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11880 @cindex separate debugging information files
11881 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11882 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11883 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11884 @cindex global debugging information directory
11885
11886 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11887 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11888 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11889 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11890 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11891 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11892 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11893
11894 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11895 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11896 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11897 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11898 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11899 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11900 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11901 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11902 places:
11903
11904 @itemize @bullet
11905 @item
11906 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11907 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11908 @item
11909 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11910 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11911 @item
11912 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11913 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11914 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11915 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11916 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11917 @end itemize
11918 @noindent
11919 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11920 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11921 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11922
11923 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11924 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11925 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11926 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11927 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11928 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11929
11930 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11931 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11932
11933 @table @code
11934
11935 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11936 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11937 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11938 information files to @var{directory}.
11939
11940 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11941 @item show debug-file-directory
11942 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11943 information files.
11944
11945 @end table
11946
11947 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11948 @cindex debug links
11949 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11950 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11951
11952 @itemize
11953 @item
11954 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11955 a zero byte,
11956 @item
11957 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11958 boundary within the section, and
11959 @item
11960 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11961 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11962 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11963 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11964 @end itemize
11965
11966 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11967 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11968 described above.
11969
11970 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11971 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11972 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11973 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11974 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11975 in an ordinary executable.
11976
11977 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11978 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11979 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11980 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11981 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11982 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11983 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11984
11985 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11986 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11987 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11988 complete code for a function that computes it:
11989
11990 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11991 @smallexample
11992 unsigned long
11993 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11994 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11995 @{
11996 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11997 @{
11998 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11999 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12000 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12001 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12002 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12003 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12004 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12005 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12006 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12007 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12008 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12009 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12010 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12011 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12012 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12013 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12014 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12015 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12016 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12017 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12018 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12019 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12020 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12021 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12022 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12023 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12024 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12025 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12026 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12027 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12028 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12029 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12030 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12031 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12032 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12033 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12034 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12035 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12036 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12037 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12038 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12039 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12040 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12041 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12042 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12043 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12044 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12045 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12046 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12047 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12048 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12049 0x2d02ef8d
12050 @};
12051 unsigned char *end;
12052
12053 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12054 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12055 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12056 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12057 @}
12058 @end smallexample
12059
12060
12061 @node Symbol Errors
12062 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12063
12064 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12065 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12066 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12067 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12068 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12069 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12070 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12071 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12072 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12073 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12074 Messages}).
12075
12076 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12077
12078 @table @code
12079 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12080
12081 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12082 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12083 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12084 in its outer scope blocks.
12085
12086 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12087 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12088 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12089 function.
12090
12091 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12092
12093 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12094 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12095 do so.
12096
12097 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12098 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12099 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12100 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12101 Messages}.)
12102
12103 @item bad block start address patched
12104
12105 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12106 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12107 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12108
12109 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12110 starting on the previous source line.
12111
12112 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12113
12114 @cindex foo
12115 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12116 larger than the size of the string table.
12117
12118 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12119 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12120 with this name.
12121
12122 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12123
12124 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12125 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12126 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12127
12128 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12129 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12130 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12131 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12132 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12133 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12134
12135 @item stub type has NULL name
12136
12137 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12138
12139 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12140 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12141 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12142 it.
12143
12144 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12145
12146 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12147
12148 @end table
12149
12150 @node Targets
12151 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12152
12153 @cindex debugging target
12154 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12155
12156 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12157 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12158 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12159 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12160 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12161 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12162 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12163 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12164
12165 @cindex target architecture
12166 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12167 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12168 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12169 command.
12170
12171 @table @code
12172 @kindex set architecture
12173 @kindex show architecture
12174 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12175 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12176 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12177 supported architectures.
12178
12179 @item show architecture
12180 Show the current target architecture.
12181
12182 @item set processor
12183 @itemx processor
12184 @kindex set processor
12185 @kindex show processor
12186 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12187 and @code{show architecture}.
12188 @end table
12189
12190 @menu
12191 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12192 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12193 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12194 @end menu
12195
12196 @node Active Targets
12197 @section Active Targets
12198
12199 @cindex stacking targets
12200 @cindex active targets
12201 @cindex multiple targets
12202
12203 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12204 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12205 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12206 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12207 a core file.
12208
12209 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12210 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12211 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12212 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12213 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12214 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12215 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12216 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12217 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12218
12219 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12220 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12221 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12222 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12223 process target is active.
12224
12225 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12226 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12227 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12228 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12229 Process}).
12230
12231 @node Target Commands
12232 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12233
12234 @table @code
12235 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12236 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12237 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12238 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12239 protocol of the target machine.
12240
12241 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12242 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12243 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12244
12245 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12246 after executing the command.
12247
12248 @kindex help target
12249 @item help target
12250 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12251 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12252 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12253
12254 @item help target @var{name}
12255 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12256 select it.
12257
12258 @kindex set gnutarget
12259 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12260 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12261 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12262 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12263 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12264 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12265
12266 @quotation
12267 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12268 you must know the actual BFD name.
12269 @end quotation
12270
12271 @noindent
12272 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12273
12274 @kindex show gnutarget
12275 @item show gnutarget
12276 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12277 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12278 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12279 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12280 @end table
12281
12282 @cindex common targets
12283 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12284 configuration):
12285
12286 @table @code
12287 @kindex target
12288 @item target exec @var{program}
12289 @cindex executable file target
12290 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12291 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12292
12293 @item target core @var{filename}
12294 @cindex core dump file target
12295 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12296 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12297
12298 @item target remote @var{medium}
12299 @cindex remote target
12300 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12301 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12302 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12303
12304 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12305 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12306
12307 @smallexample
12308 target remote /dev/ttya
12309 @end smallexample
12310
12311 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12312 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12313 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12314 clobbered by the download.
12315
12316 @item target sim
12317 @cindex built-in simulator target
12318 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12319 In general,
12320 @smallexample
12321 target sim
12322 load
12323 run
12324 @end smallexample
12325 @noindent
12326 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12327 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12328 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12329 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12330 Processors}.
12331
12332 @end table
12333
12334 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12335
12336 @table @code
12337
12338 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12339 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12340 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12341
12342 @end table
12343
12344 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12345 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12346
12347 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12348 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12349 various aspects of this process.
12350
12351 @table @code
12352
12353 @item set hash
12354 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12355 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12356 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12357 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12358 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12359 monitor.
12360
12361 @item show hash
12362 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12363 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12364
12365 @item set debug monitor
12366 @kindex set debug monitor
12367 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12368 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12369 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12370
12371 @item show debug monitor
12372 @kindex show debug monitor
12373 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12374 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12375 @end table
12376
12377 @table @code
12378
12379 @kindex load @var{filename}
12380 @item load @var{filename}
12381 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12382 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12383 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12384 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12385 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12386 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12387
12388 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12389 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12390 target is @dots{}}''
12391
12392 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12393 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12394 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12395 specifies a fixed address.
12396 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12397
12398 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12399 load programs into flash memory.
12400
12401 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12402 @end table
12403
12404 @node Byte Order
12405 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12406
12407 @cindex choosing target byte order
12408 @cindex target byte order
12409
12410 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12411 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12412 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12413 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12414 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12415 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12416
12417 @table @code
12418 @kindex set endian
12419 @item set endian big
12420 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12421
12422 @item set endian little
12423 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12424
12425 @item set endian auto
12426 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12427 executable.
12428
12429 @item show endian
12430 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12431
12432 @end table
12433
12434 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12435 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12436 target system.
12437
12438
12439 @node Remote Debugging
12440 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12441 @cindex remote debugging
12442
12443 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12444 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12445 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12446 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12447 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12448
12449 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12450 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12451 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12452 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12453 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12454 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12455
12456 Other remote targets may be available in your
12457 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12458
12459 @menu
12460 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12461 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12462 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12463 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12464 @end menu
12465
12466 @node Connecting
12467 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12468
12469 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12470 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12471 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12472 program as the first argument.
12473
12474 @cindex @code{target remote}
12475 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12476 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12477 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12478 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12479 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12480 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12481
12482 @table @code
12483
12484 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12485 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12486 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12487 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12488
12489 @smallexample
12490 target remote /dev/ttyb
12491 @end smallexample
12492
12493 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12494 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12495 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12496 @code{target} command.
12497
12498 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12499 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12500 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12501 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12502 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12503 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12504 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12505 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12506 target.
12507
12508 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12509 @code{manyfarms}:
12510
12511 @smallexample
12512 target remote manyfarms:2828
12513 @end smallexample
12514
12515 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12516 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12517 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12518 port 1234 on your local machine:
12519
12520 @smallexample
12521 target remote :1234
12522 @end smallexample
12523 @noindent
12524
12525 Note that the colon is still required here.
12526
12527 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12528 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12529 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12530 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12531
12532 @smallexample
12533 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12534 @end smallexample
12535
12536 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12537 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12538 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12539 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12540
12541 @item target remote | @var{command}
12542 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12543 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12544 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12545 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12546 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12547 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12548 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12549 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12550
12551 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12552 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12553 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12554
12555 @end table
12556
12557 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12558 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12559 remote program.
12560
12561 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12562 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12563 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12564 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12565 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12566 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12567 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12568
12569 @smallexample
12570 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12571 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12572 @end smallexample
12573
12574 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12575 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12576 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12577 goes back to waiting.
12578
12579 @table @code
12580 @kindex detach (remote)
12581 @item detach
12582 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12583 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12584 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12585 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12586 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12587
12588 @kindex disconnect
12589 @item disconnect
12590 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12591 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12592 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12593 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12594 another target.
12595
12596 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12597 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12598 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12599 @kindex monitor
12600 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12601 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12602 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12603 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12604 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12605 and implement.
12606 @end table
12607
12608 @node Server
12609 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12610
12611 @kindex gdbserver
12612 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12613 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12614 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12615 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12616
12617 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12618 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12619 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12620 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12621 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12622 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12623 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12624 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12625 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12626 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12627 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12628 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12629 choice for debugging.
12630
12631 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12632 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12633 protocol.
12634
12635 @table @emph
12636 @item On the target machine,
12637 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12638 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12639 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12640 system does all the symbol handling.
12641
12642 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12643 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12644 syntax is:
12645
12646 @smallexample
12647 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12648 @end smallexample
12649
12650 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12651 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12652 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12653 @file{/dev/com1}:
12654
12655 @smallexample
12656 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12657 @end smallexample
12658
12659 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12660 with it.
12661
12662 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12663
12664 @smallexample
12665 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12666 @end smallexample
12667
12668 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12669 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12670 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12671 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12672 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12673 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12674 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12675 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12676 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12677 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12678 @code{target remote} command.
12679
12680 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12681 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12682
12683 @smallexample
12684 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12685 @end smallexample
12686
12687 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12688 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12689
12690 @pindex pidof
12691 @cindex attach to a program by name
12692 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12693 @code{pidof} utility:
12694
12695 @smallexample
12696 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
12697 @end smallexample
12698
12699 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
12700 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12701 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12702
12703 @item On the host machine,
12704 first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
12705 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
12706 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
12707 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
12708
12709 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
12710 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
12711 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
12712 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
12713 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
12714 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
12715 programs.
12716
12717 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
12718 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12719 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12720 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12721 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12722 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12723 already on the target.
12724
12725 @end table
12726
12727 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
12728 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
12729
12730 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
12731 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
12732 Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
12733 debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
12734
12735 @table @code
12736 @item monitor help
12737 List the available monitor commands.
12738
12739 @item monitor set debug 0
12740 @itemx monitor set debug 1
12741 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
12742
12743 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
12744 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
12745 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
12746 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
12747
12748 @end table
12749
12750 @node Remote Configuration
12751 @section Remote Configuration
12752
12753 @kindex set remote
12754 @kindex show remote
12755 This section documents the configuration options available when
12756 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12757 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12758 system-call-allowed}.
12759
12760 @table @code
12761 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12762 @cindex address size for remote targets
12763 @cindex bits in remote address
12764 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12765 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12766 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12767 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12768
12769 @item show remoteaddresssize
12770 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12771
12772 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12773 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12774 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12775 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12776 remote targets.
12777
12778 @item show remotebaud
12779 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12780
12781 @item set remotebreak
12782 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12783 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12784 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12785 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12786 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12787 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12788 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12789 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12790
12791 @item show remotebreak
12792 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12793 interrupt the remote program.
12794
12795 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12796 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12797 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12798 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12799 @code{ascii}.
12800
12801 @item show remotelogbase
12802 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12803 protocol.
12804
12805 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12806 @cindex record serial communications on file
12807 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12808 default is not to record at all.
12809
12810 @item show remotelogfile.
12811 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12812 serial communications.
12813
12814 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12815 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12816 @cindex remote timeout
12817 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12818 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12819
12820 @item show remotetimeout
12821 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12822 responses.
12823
12824 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12825 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12826 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12827 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12828 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12829 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12830 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12831 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12832 @end table
12833
12834 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12835 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12836 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12837 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12838 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12839 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
12840 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
12841 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
12842 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
12843
12844 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
12845 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
12846 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
12847 @value{GDBN} developers.
12848
12849 The available settings are:
12850
12851 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.2 0.35
12852 @item Command Name
12853 @tab Remote Packet
12854 @tab Related Features
12855
12856 @item @code{fetch-register-packet}
12857 @tab @code{p}
12858 @tab @code{info registers}
12859
12860 @item @code{set-register-packet}
12861 @tab @code{P}
12862 @tab @code{set}
12863
12864 @item @code{binary-download-packet}
12865 @tab @code{X}
12866 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
12867
12868 @item @code{read-aux-vector-packet}
12869 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
12870 @tab @code{info auxv}
12871
12872 @item @code{symbol-lookup-packet}
12873 @tab @code{qSymbol}
12874 @tab Detecting multiple threads
12875
12876 @item @code{verbose-resume-packet}
12877 @tab @code{vCont}
12878 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
12879
12880 @item @code{software-breakpoint-packet}
12881 @tab @code{Z0}
12882 @tab @code{break}
12883
12884 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint-packet}
12885 @tab @code{Z1}
12886 @tab @code{hbreak}
12887
12888 @item @code{write-watchpoint-packet}
12889 @tab @code{Z2}
12890 @tab @code{watch}
12891
12892 @item @code{read-watchpoint-packet}
12893 @tab @code{Z3}
12894 @tab @code{rwatch}
12895
12896 @item @code{access-watchpoint-packet}
12897 @tab @code{Z4}
12898 @tab @code{awatch}
12899
12900 @item @code{get-thread-local-storage-address-packet}
12901 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
12902 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
12903
12904 @item @code{supported-packets}
12905 @tab @code{qSupported}
12906 @tab Remote communications parameters
12907
12908 @item @code{pass-signals-packet}
12909 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
12910 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
12911
12912 @end multitable
12913
12914 @node Remote Stub
12915 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
12916
12917 @cindex debugging stub, example
12918 @cindex remote stub, example
12919 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12920 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12921 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12922 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12923 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12924 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12925 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12926 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12927
12928 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12929 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12930 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12931 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12932 program, you need:
12933
12934 @enumerate
12935 @item
12936 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12937 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12938 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12939
12940 @item
12941 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12942 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12943
12944 @item
12945 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12946 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12947 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12948 documentation.
12949 @end enumerate
12950
12951 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12952 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12953 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12954
12955 @table @emph
12956 @item On the host,
12957 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12958 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12959 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12960
12961 @item On the target,
12962 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12963 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12964 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12965
12966 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12967 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12968 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
12969 @end table
12970
12971 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12972 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12973 @sc{sparc} boards.
12974
12975 @cindex remote serial stub list
12976 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12977
12978 @table @code
12979
12980 @item i386-stub.c
12981 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12982 @cindex Intel
12983 @cindex i386
12984 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12985
12986 @item m68k-stub.c
12987 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12988 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12989 @cindex m680x0
12990 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12991
12992 @item sh-stub.c
12993 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12994 @cindex Renesas
12995 @cindex SH
12996 For Renesas SH architectures.
12997
12998 @item sparc-stub.c
12999 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13000 @cindex Sparc
13001 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13002
13003 @item sparcl-stub.c
13004 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13005 @cindex Fujitsu
13006 @cindex SparcLite
13007 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13008
13009 @end table
13010
13011 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13012 recently added stubs.
13013
13014 @menu
13015 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13016 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13017 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13018 @end menu
13019
13020 @node Stub Contents
13021 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13022
13023 @cindex remote serial stub
13024 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13025 subroutines:
13026
13027 @table @code
13028 @item set_debug_traps
13029 @findex set_debug_traps
13030 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13031 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13032 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13033 beginning of your program.
13034
13035 @item handle_exception
13036 @findex handle_exception
13037 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13038 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13039 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13040 run when a trap is triggered.
13041
13042 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13043 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13044 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13045 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13046 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13047 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13048 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13049 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13050 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13051 machine.
13052
13053 @item breakpoint
13054 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13055 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13056 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13057 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13058 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13059 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13060 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13061 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13062 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13063 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13064 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13065
13066 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13067 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13068 start of your debugging session.
13069 @end table
13070
13071 @node Bootstrapping
13072 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13073
13074 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13075 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13076 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13077 debugging target machine.
13078
13079 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13080 serial port.
13081
13082 @table @code
13083 @item int getDebugChar()
13084 @findex getDebugChar
13085 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13086 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13087 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13088
13089 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13090 @findex putDebugChar
13091 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13092 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13093 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13094 @end table
13095
13096 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13097 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13098 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13099 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13100 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13101 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13102 remote system to stop.
13103
13104 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13105 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13106 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13107 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13108
13109 Other routines you need to supply are:
13110
13111 @table @code
13112 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13113 @findex exceptionHandler
13114 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13115 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13116 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13117 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13118 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13119 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13120 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13121 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13122 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13123 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13124 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13125 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13126 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13127
13128 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13129 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13130 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13131 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13132 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13133
13134 @item void flush_i_cache()
13135 @findex flush_i_cache
13136 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13137 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13138 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13139
13140 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13141 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13142 @end table
13143
13144 @noindent
13145 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13146
13147 @table @code
13148 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13149 @findex memset
13150 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13151 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13152 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13153 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13154 @end table
13155
13156 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13157 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13158 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13159 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13160
13161
13162 @node Debug Session
13163 @subsection Putting it All Together
13164
13165 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13166 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13167 steps.
13168
13169 @enumerate
13170 @item
13171 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13172 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13173 @display
13174 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13175 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13176 @end display
13177
13178 @item
13179 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13180
13181 @smallexample
13182 set_debug_traps();
13183 breakpoint();
13184 @end smallexample
13185
13186 @item
13187 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13188 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13189
13190 @smallexample
13191 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13192 @end smallexample
13193
13194 @noindent
13195 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13196 function in your program, that function is called when
13197 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13198 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13199 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13200
13201 @item
13202 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13203 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13204
13205 @item
13206 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13207 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13208
13209 @item
13210 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13211 @c document that. FIXME.
13212 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13213 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13214
13215 @item
13216 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13217 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13218
13219 @end enumerate
13220
13221 @node Configurations
13222 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13223
13224 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13225 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13226 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13227
13228 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13229 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13230 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13231 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13232 are quite different from each other.
13233
13234 @menu
13235 * Native::
13236 * Embedded OS::
13237 * Embedded Processors::
13238 * Architectures::
13239 @end menu
13240
13241 @node Native
13242 @section Native
13243
13244 This section describes details specific to particular native
13245 configurations.
13246
13247 @menu
13248 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13249 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13250 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13251 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13252 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13253 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13254 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13255 @end menu
13256
13257 @node HP-UX
13258 @subsection HP-UX
13259
13260 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13261 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13262 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13263
13264
13265 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13266 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13267
13268 @cindex libkvm
13269 @cindex kernel memory image
13270 @cindex kernel crash dump
13271
13272 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13273 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13274 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13275 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13276 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13277 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13278 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13279 @code{kvm} target:
13280
13281 @smallexample
13282 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13283 @end smallexample
13284
13285 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13286 argument:
13287
13288 @smallexample
13289 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13290 @end smallexample
13291
13292 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13293 available:
13294
13295 @table @code
13296 @kindex kvm
13297 @item kvm pcb
13298 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13299
13300 @item kvm proc
13301 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13302 modern FreeBSD systems.
13303 @end table
13304
13305 @node SVR4 Process Information
13306 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13307 @cindex /proc
13308 @cindex examine process image
13309 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13310
13311 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13312 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13313 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13314 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13315 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13316 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13317 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13318 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13319 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13320
13321 @table @code
13322 @kindex info proc
13323 @cindex process ID
13324 @item info proc
13325 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13326 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13327 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13328 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13329 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13330 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13331 executable file's absolute file name.
13332
13333 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13334 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13335 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13336 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13337 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13338 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13339
13340 @item info proc mappings
13341 @cindex memory address space mappings
13342 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13343 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13344 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13345 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13346 memory access rights to that range.
13347
13348 @item info proc stat
13349 @itemx info proc status
13350 @cindex process detailed status information
13351 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13352 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13353 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13354 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13355 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13356 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13357 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13358
13359 @item info proc all
13360 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13361 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13362
13363 @ignore
13364 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13365 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13366 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13367 @kindex info proc times
13368 @item info proc times
13369 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13370 its children.
13371
13372 @kindex info proc id
13373 @item info proc id
13374 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13375 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13376 @end ignore
13377
13378 @item set procfs-trace
13379 @kindex set procfs-trace
13380 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13381 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13382
13383 @item show procfs-trace
13384 @kindex show procfs-trace
13385 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13386
13387 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13388 @kindex set procfs-file
13389 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13390 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13391 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13392 standard output.
13393
13394 @item show procfs-file
13395 @kindex show procfs-file
13396 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13397
13398 @item proc-trace-entry
13399 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13400 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13401 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13402 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13403 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13404 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13405 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13406 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13407 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13408
13409 @item info pidlist
13410 @kindex info pidlist
13411 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13412 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13413 processes and all the threads within each process.
13414
13415 @item info meminfo
13416 @kindex info meminfo
13417 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13418 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13419 @end table
13420
13421 @node DJGPP Native
13422 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13423 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13424 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13425 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13426
13427 @cindex DPMI
13428 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13429 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13430 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13431 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13432
13433 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13434 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13435 subsection describes those commands.
13436
13437 @table @code
13438 @kindex info dos
13439 @item info dos
13440 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13441 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13442
13443 @kindex sysinfo
13444 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13445 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13446 @item info dos sysinfo
13447 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13448 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13449 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13450
13451 @cindex GDT
13452 @cindex LDT
13453 @cindex IDT
13454 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13455 @cindex descriptor tables display
13456 @item info dos gdt
13457 @itemx info dos ldt
13458 @itemx info dos idt
13459 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13460 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13461 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13462 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13463 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13464 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13465 rights.
13466
13467 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13468 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13469 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13470 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13471 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13472
13473 @cindex garbled pointers
13474 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13475 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13476 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13477 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13478 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13479 debugged program's data segment:
13480
13481 @smallexample
13482 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13483 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13484 @end smallexample
13485
13486 @noindent
13487 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13488 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13489
13490 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13491 @item info dos pde
13492 @itemx info dos pte
13493 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13494 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13495 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13496 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13497 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13498 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13499 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13500 that is currently in use.
13501
13502 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13503 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13504 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13505 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13506 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13507 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13508 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13509
13510 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13511 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13512 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13513 controller.
13514
13515 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13516
13517 @cindex physical address from linear address
13518 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13519 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13520 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13521 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13522 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13523 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13524 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13525
13526 @smallexample
13527 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13528 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13529 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13530 @end smallexample
13531
13532 @noindent
13533 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13534 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13535 attributes of that page.
13536
13537 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13538 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13539 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13540 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13541 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13542 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13543
13544 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13545 transfer buffer:
13546
13547 @smallexample
13548 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13549 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13550 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13551 @end smallexample
13552
13553 @noindent
13554 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13555 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13556 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13557 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13558 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13559
13560 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13561 @end table
13562
13563 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13564 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13565 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13566 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13567
13568 @table @code
13569 @kindex set com1base
13570 @kindex set com1irq
13571 @kindex set com2base
13572 @kindex set com2irq
13573 @kindex set com3base
13574 @kindex set com3irq
13575 @kindex set com4base
13576 @kindex set com4irq
13577 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13578 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13579 port.
13580
13581 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13582 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13583 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13584
13585 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13586 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13587 other 3 COM ports.
13588
13589 @kindex show com1base
13590 @kindex show com1irq
13591 @kindex show com2base
13592 @kindex show com2irq
13593 @kindex show com3base
13594 @kindex show com3irq
13595 @kindex show com4base
13596 @kindex show com4irq
13597 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13598 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13599 lines used by the COM ports.
13600
13601 @item info serial
13602 @kindex info serial
13603 @cindex DOS serial port status
13604 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13605 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13606 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13607 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13608 @end table
13609
13610
13611 @node Cygwin Native
13612 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
13613 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13614 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13615 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13616
13617 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13618 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13619 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
13620 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
13621 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
13622
13623 @table @code
13624 @kindex info w32
13625 @item info w32
13626 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
13627 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13628
13629 @item info w32 selector
13630 This command displays information returned by
13631 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13632 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13633 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13634 Without argument, this command displays information
13635 about the six segment registers.
13636
13637 @kindex info dll
13638 @item info dll
13639 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
13640
13641 @kindex dll-symbols
13642 @item dll-symbols
13643 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13644 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13645
13646 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13647 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13648 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13649 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13650 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13651 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13652 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13653 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13654 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13655 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13656 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13657
13658 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13659 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13660 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13661 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13662
13663 @kindex set new-console
13664 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13665 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13666 be started in a new console on next start.
13667 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13668 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13669
13670 @kindex show new-console
13671 @item show new-console
13672 Displays whether a new console is used
13673 when the debuggee is started.
13674
13675 @kindex set new-group
13676 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13677 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13678 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13679 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13680 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13681
13682 @kindex show new-group
13683 @item show new-group
13684 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13685
13686 @kindex set debugevents
13687 @item set debugevents
13688 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13689 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13690 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13691 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13692 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13693
13694 @kindex set debugexec
13695 @item set debugexec
13696 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13697 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13698
13699 @kindex set debugexceptions
13700 @item set debugexceptions
13701 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13702 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13703
13704 @kindex set debugmemory
13705 @item set debugmemory
13706 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13707 and writes by the debugger.
13708
13709 @kindex set shell
13710 @item set shell
13711 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13712 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13713
13714 @kindex show shell
13715 @item show shell
13716 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13717
13718 @end table
13719
13720 @menu
13721 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13722 @end menu
13723
13724 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
13725 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
13726 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13727 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13728
13729 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13730 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13731 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13732 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13733 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
13734 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13735 ``minimal symbols''.
13736
13737 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13738 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13739 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13740 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13741 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13742 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
13743 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13744 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13745 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13746 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13747
13748 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
13749
13750 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13751 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13752 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13753 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13754 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13755 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13756 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13757 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13758 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13759
13760 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13761 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13762 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13763 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13764 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
13765 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13766
13767 @smallexample
13768 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13769 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13770
13771 Non-debugging symbols:
13772 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13773 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13774 @end smallexample
13775
13776 @smallexample
13777 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13778 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13779
13780 Non-debugging symbols:
13781 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13782 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13783 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13784 [etc...]
13785 @end smallexample
13786
13787 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
13788
13789 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13790 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13791 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13792 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13793 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13794 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13795 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13796
13797 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13798 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13799 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13800 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13801 problem:
13802
13803 @smallexample
13804 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13805 $1 = 268572168
13806 @end smallexample
13807
13808 @smallexample
13809 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13810 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13811 @end smallexample
13812
13813 And two possible solutions:
13814
13815 @smallexample
13816 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13817 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13818 @end smallexample
13819
13820 @smallexample
13821 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13822 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13823 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13824 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13825 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13826 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13827 @end smallexample
13828
13829 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13830 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13831 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13832 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13833 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13834
13835 @smallexample
13836 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13837 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13838 @end smallexample
13839
13840 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13841 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13842 safe.
13843
13844 @node Hurd Native
13845 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
13846 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13847
13848 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13849 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13850
13851 @table @code
13852 @item set signals
13853 @itemx set sigs
13854 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13855 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13856 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13857 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13858 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13859 @code{signals}.
13860
13861 @item show signals
13862 @itemx show sigs
13863 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13864 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13865 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13866
13867 @item set signal-thread
13868 @itemx set sigthread
13869 @kindex set signal-thread
13870 @kindex set sigthread
13871 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13872 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13873 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13874 signal-thread}.
13875
13876 @item show signal-thread
13877 @itemx show sigthread
13878 @kindex show signal-thread
13879 @kindex show sigthread
13880 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13881 delivered a signal.
13882
13883 @item set stopped
13884 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13885 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13886 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13887 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13888
13889 @item show stopped
13890 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13891 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13892 stopped.
13893
13894 @item set exceptions
13895 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13896 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13897 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13898 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13899 trapping on.
13900
13901 @item show exceptions
13902 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13903 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13904
13905 @item set task pause
13906 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13907 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13908 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13909 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13910 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13911 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13912 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13913 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13914 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13915
13916 @item show task pause
13917 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13918 Show the current state of task suspension.
13919
13920 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13921 @cindex task suspend count
13922 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13923 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13924 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13925
13926 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13927 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13928
13929 @item set task exception-port
13930 @itemx set task excp
13931 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13932 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13933 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13934 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13935
13936 @item set noninvasive
13937 @cindex noninvasive task options
13938 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13939 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13940 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13941 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13942
13943 @item info send-rights
13944 @itemx info receive-rights
13945 @itemx info port-rights
13946 @itemx info port-sets
13947 @itemx info dead-names
13948 @itemx info ports
13949 @itemx info psets
13950 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13951 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13952 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13953 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13954 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13955 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13956 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13957 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13958 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13959
13960 @item set thread pause
13961 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13962 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13963 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13964 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13965 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13966 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13967 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13968 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13969 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13970 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13971 only the current thread.
13972
13973 @item show thread pause
13974 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13975 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13976
13977 @item set thread run
13978 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13979
13980 @item show thread run
13981 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13982
13983 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13984 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13985 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13986 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13987 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13988 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13989 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13990
13991 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13992 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13993 detaching.
13994
13995 @item set thread exception-port
13996 @itemx set thread excp
13997 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13998 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13999 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14000
14001 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14002 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14003 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14004 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14005
14006 @item set thread default
14007 @itemx show thread default
14008 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14009 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14010 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14011 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14012 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14013 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14014 the non-default commands.
14015 @end table
14016
14017
14018 @node Neutrino
14019 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14020 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14021
14022 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14023 Neutrino target:
14024
14025 @table @code
14026 @item set debug nto-debug
14027 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14028 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14029 Neutrino support.
14030
14031 @item show debug nto-debug
14032 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14033 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14034 @end table
14035
14036
14037 @node Embedded OS
14038 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14039
14040 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14041 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14042 architectures.
14043
14044 @menu
14045 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14046 @end menu
14047
14048 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14049 various real-time operating systems.
14050
14051 @node VxWorks
14052 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14053
14054 @cindex VxWorks
14055
14056 @table @code
14057
14058 @kindex target vxworks
14059 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14060 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14061 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14062
14063 @end table
14064
14065 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14066 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14067
14068 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14069 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14070 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14071 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14072 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14073 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14074 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14075
14076 @table @code
14077 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14078 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14079 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14080 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14081 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14082 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14083 of a thin network line.
14084 @end table
14085
14086 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14087 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14088 procedures.
14089
14090 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14091 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14092 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14093 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14094 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14095 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14096 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14097 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14098 manual.
14099 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14100
14101 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14102 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14103 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14104 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14105
14106 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14107
14108 @smallexample
14109 (vxgdb)
14110 @end smallexample
14111
14112 @menu
14113 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14114 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14115 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14116 @end menu
14117
14118 @node VxWorks Connection
14119 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14120
14121 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14122 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14123
14124 @smallexample
14125 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14126 @end smallexample
14127
14128 @need 750
14129 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14130
14131 @smallexample
14132 Attaching remote machine across net...
14133 Connected to tt.
14134 @end smallexample
14135
14136 @need 1000
14137 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14138 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14139 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14140 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14141 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14142
14143 @smallexample
14144 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14145 @end smallexample
14146
14147 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14148 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14149 command again.
14150
14151 @node VxWorks Download
14152 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14153
14154 @cindex download to VxWorks
14155 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14156 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14157 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14158 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14159 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14160 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14161 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14162 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14163 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14164 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14165 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14166 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14167 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14168 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14169 program, type this on VxWorks:
14170
14171 @smallexample
14172 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14173 @end smallexample
14174
14175 @noindent
14176 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14177
14178 @smallexample
14179 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14180 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14181 @end smallexample
14182
14183 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14184
14185 @smallexample
14186 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14187 @end smallexample
14188
14189 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14190 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14191 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14192 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14193 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14194 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14195 table.)
14196
14197 @node VxWorks Attach
14198 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14199
14200 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14201 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14202 follows:
14203
14204 @smallexample
14205 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14206 @end smallexample
14207
14208 @noindent
14209 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14210 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14211 the time of attachment.
14212
14213 @node Embedded Processors
14214 @section Embedded Processors
14215
14216 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14217 configurations.
14218
14219 @cindex send command to simulator
14220 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14221 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14222
14223 @table @code
14224 @item sim @var{command}
14225 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14226 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14227 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14228 acceptable commands.
14229 @end table
14230
14231
14232 @menu
14233 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14234 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14235 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14236 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14237 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14238 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14239 * PowerPC:: PowerPC
14240 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14241 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14242 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14243 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14244 * CRIS:: CRIS
14245 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14246 @end menu
14247
14248 @node ARM
14249 @subsection ARM
14250 @cindex ARM RDI
14251
14252 @table @code
14253 @kindex target rdi
14254 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14255 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14256 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14257 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14258
14259 @kindex target rdp
14260 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14261 ARM Demon monitor.
14262
14263 @end table
14264
14265 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14266
14267 @table @code
14268 @item set arm disassembler
14269 @kindex set arm
14270 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14271 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14272
14273 @item show arm disassembler
14274 @kindex show arm
14275 Show the current disassembly style.
14276
14277 @item set arm apcs32
14278 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14279 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14280
14281 @item show arm apcs32
14282 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14283
14284 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14285 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14286 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14287
14288 @table @code
14289 @item auto
14290 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14291 @item softfpa
14292 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14293 processors.
14294 @item fpa
14295 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14296 @item softvfp
14297 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14298 @item vfp
14299 VFP co-processor.
14300 @end table
14301
14302 @item show arm fpu
14303 Show the current type of the FPU.
14304
14305 @item set arm abi
14306 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14307
14308 @item show arm abi
14309 Show the currently used ABI.
14310
14311 @item set debug arm
14312 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14313 target support subsystem.
14314
14315 @item show debug arm
14316 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14317 @end table
14318
14319 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14320 using the RDI interface:
14321
14322 @table @code
14323 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14324 @kindex rdilogfile
14325 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14326 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14327 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14328 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14329 @file{rdi.log}.
14330
14331 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14332 @kindex rdilogenable
14333 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14334 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14335 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14336 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14337 are logged to a file.
14338
14339 @item set rdiromatzero
14340 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14341 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14342 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14343 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14344 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14345 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14346
14347 @item show rdiromatzero
14348 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14349 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14350
14351 @item set rdiheartbeat
14352 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14353 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14354 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14355 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14356 well as the Angel monitor.
14357
14358 @item show rdiheartbeat
14359 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14360 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14361 @end table
14362
14363
14364 @node M32R/D
14365 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14366
14367 @table @code
14368 @kindex target m32r
14369 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14370 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14371
14372 @kindex target m32rsdi
14373 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14374 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14375 @end table
14376
14377 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14378
14379 @table @code
14380 @item set download-path @var{path}
14381 @kindex set download-path
14382 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14383 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14384
14385 @item show download-path
14386 @kindex show download-path
14387 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14388
14389 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14390 @kindex set board-address
14391 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14392 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14393
14394 @item show board-address
14395 @kindex show board-address
14396 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14397
14398 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14399 @kindex set server-address
14400 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14401 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14402 host machine.
14403
14404 @item show server-address
14405 @kindex show server-address
14406 Display the IP address of the download server.
14407
14408 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14409 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14410 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14411 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14412 executable file is uploaded.
14413
14414 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14415 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14416 Test the @code{upload} command.
14417 @end table
14418
14419 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14420
14421 @table @code
14422 @item sdireset
14423 @kindex sdireset
14424 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14425 This command resets the SDI connection.
14426
14427 @item sdistatus
14428 @kindex sdistatus
14429 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14430
14431 @item debug_chaos
14432 @kindex debug_chaos
14433 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14434 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14435
14436 @item use_debug_dma
14437 @kindex use_debug_dma
14438 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14439
14440 @item use_mon_code
14441 @kindex use_mon_code
14442 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14443
14444 @item use_ib_break
14445 @kindex use_ib_break
14446 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14447
14448 @item use_dbt_break
14449 @kindex use_dbt_break
14450 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14451 @end table
14452
14453 @node M68K
14454 @subsection M68k
14455
14456 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14457 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14458
14459 @table @code
14460
14461 @kindex target dbug
14462 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14463 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14464
14465 @end table
14466
14467 @node MIPS Embedded
14468 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14469
14470 @cindex MIPS boards
14471 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14472 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14473 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14474
14475 @need 1000
14476 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14477
14478 @table @code
14479 @item target mips @var{port}
14480 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14481 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14482 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14483 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14484 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14485 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14486 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14487
14488 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14489 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14490 debugger:
14491
14492 @smallexample
14493 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14494 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14495 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14496 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14497 (@value{GDBP}) run
14498 @end smallexample
14499
14500 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14501 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14502 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14503 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14504 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14505
14506 @item target pmon @var{port}
14507 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14508 PMON ROM monitor.
14509
14510 @item target ddb @var{port}
14511 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14512 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14513
14514 @item target lsi @var{port}
14515 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14516 LSI variant of PMON.
14517
14518 @kindex target r3900
14519 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14520 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14521
14522 @kindex target array
14523 @item target array @var{dev}
14524 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14525
14526 @end table
14527
14528
14529 @noindent
14530 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14531
14532 @table @code
14533 @item set mipsfpu double
14534 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14535 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14536 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14537 @itemx show mipsfpu
14538 @kindex set mipsfpu
14539 @kindex show mipsfpu
14540 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14541 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14542 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14543 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14544 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14545 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14546 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14547 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14548 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14549 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14550 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14551 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14552 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14553
14554 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14555 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14556 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14557
14558 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14559 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14560
14561 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14562 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14563 @itemx show timeout
14564 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14565 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14566 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14567 @kindex set timeout
14568 @kindex show timeout
14569 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14570 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14571 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14572 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14573 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14574 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14575 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14576 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14577 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14578 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14579
14580 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14581 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14582 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14583 to run before stopping.
14584
14585 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14586 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14587 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14588 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14589 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14590 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14591
14592 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14593 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14594 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14595 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14596
14597 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14598 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14599 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14600 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14601 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14602 @table @asis
14603 @item pmon target
14604 @samp{PMON}
14605 @item ddb target
14606 @samp{NEC010}
14607 @item lsi target
14608 @samp{PMON>}
14609 @end table
14610
14611 @item show monitor-prompt
14612 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14613 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14614 remote monitor.
14615
14616 @item set monitor-warnings
14617 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14618 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14619 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14620 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14621 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14622
14623 @item show monitor-warnings
14624 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14625 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14626
14627 @item pmon @var{command}
14628 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14629 @cindex send PMON command
14630 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14631 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14632 @end table
14633
14634 @node OpenRISC 1000
14635 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14636 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14637
14638 @cindex or1k boards
14639 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14640 about platform and commands.
14641
14642 @table @code
14643
14644 @kindex target jtag
14645 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14646
14647 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14648 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14649 connected via parallel port to the board.
14650
14651 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14652
14653 @kindex or1ksim
14654 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14655 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14656 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14657
14658 @kindex info or1k spr
14659 @item info or1k spr
14660 Displays spr groups.
14661
14662 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14663 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14664 Displays register names in selected group.
14665
14666 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14667 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14668 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14669 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14670 Shows information about specified spr register.
14671
14672 @kindex spr
14673 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14674 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14675 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14676 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14677 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14678 @end table
14679
14680 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14681 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14682 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14683 triggers can be set using:
14684 @table @code
14685 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14686 Load effective address/data
14687 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14688 Store effective address/data
14689 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14690 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14691 @item $FETCH
14692 Fetch data
14693 @end table
14694
14695 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14696 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14697
14698 @code{htrace} commands:
14699 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14700 @table @code
14701 @kindex hwatch
14702 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14703 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
14704 or Data. For example:
14705
14706 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14707
14708 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14709
14710 @kindex htrace
14711 @item htrace info
14712 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14713
14714 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14715 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14716
14717 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14718 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14719
14720 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14721 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14722
14723 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14724 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14725 triggered.
14726
14727 @item htrace enable
14728 @itemx htrace disable
14729 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14730
14731 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14732 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14733
14734 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14735 will be written there.
14736
14737 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14738 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14739
14740 @item htrace mode continuous
14741 Set continuous trace mode.
14742
14743 @item htrace mode suspend
14744 Set suspend trace mode.
14745
14746 @end table
14747
14748 @node PowerPC
14749 @subsection PowerPC
14750
14751 @table @code
14752 @kindex target dink32
14753 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14754 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14755
14756 @kindex target ppcbug
14757 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14758 @kindex target ppcbug1
14759 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14760 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14761
14762 @kindex target sds
14763 @item target sds @var{dev}
14764 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14765 @end table
14766
14767 @cindex SDS protocol
14768 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
14769 by@value{GDBN}:
14770
14771 @table @code
14772 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14773 @kindex set sdstimeout
14774 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14775 default is 2 seconds.
14776
14777 @item show sdstimeout
14778 @kindex show sdstimeout
14779 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
14780
14781 @item sds @var{command}
14782 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
14783 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
14784 @end table
14785
14786
14787 @node PA
14788 @subsection HP PA Embedded
14789
14790 @table @code
14791
14792 @kindex target op50n
14793 @item target op50n @var{dev}
14794 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
14795
14796 @kindex target w89k
14797 @item target w89k @var{dev}
14798 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
14799
14800 @end table
14801
14802 @node Sparclet
14803 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
14804
14805 @cindex Sparclet
14806
14807 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
14808 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
14809 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14810 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
14811 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
14812
14813 @table @code
14814 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
14815 @kindex remotetimeout
14816 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
14817 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14818 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
14819 @end table
14820
14821 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
14822 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
14823 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
14824 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
14825 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
14826
14827 @smallexample
14828 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
14829 @end smallexample
14830
14831 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
14832
14833 @smallexample
14834 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
14835 @end smallexample
14836
14837 @cindex running, on Sparclet
14838 Once you have set
14839 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14840 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
14841 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
14842
14843 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14844
14845 @smallexample
14846 (gdbslet)
14847 @end smallexample
14848
14849 @menu
14850 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
14851 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
14852 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
14853 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
14854 @end menu
14855
14856 @node Sparclet File
14857 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
14858
14859 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
14860
14861 @smallexample
14862 (gdbslet) file prog
14863 @end smallexample
14864
14865 @need 1000
14866 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
14867 @value{GDBN} locates
14868 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
14869 path.
14870 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
14871 files will be searched as well.
14872 @value{GDBN} locates
14873 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
14874 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
14875 If it fails
14876 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
14877
14878 @smallexample
14879 prog: No such file or directory.
14880 @end smallexample
14881
14882 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
14883 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
14884 @code{target} command again.
14885
14886 @node Sparclet Connection
14887 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
14888
14889 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
14890 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
14891
14892 @smallexample
14893 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
14894 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
14895 main () at ../prog.c:3
14896 @end smallexample
14897
14898 @need 750
14899 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14900
14901 @smallexample
14902 Connected to ttya.
14903 @end smallexample
14904
14905 @node Sparclet Download
14906 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
14907
14908 @cindex download to Sparclet
14909 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
14910 you can use the @value{GDBN}
14911 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
14912 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
14913 command.
14914 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
14915 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
14916 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
14917 of each of the file's sections.
14918 For instance, if the program
14919 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
14920 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14921
14922 @smallexample
14923 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
14924 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
14925 @end smallexample
14926
14927 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
14928 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
14929 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
14930
14931 @node Sparclet Execution
14932 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
14933
14934 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
14935 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
14936 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
14937 manual for the list of commands.
14938
14939 @smallexample
14940 (gdbslet) b main
14941 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
14942 (gdbslet) run
14943 Starting program: prog
14944 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
14945 3 char *symarg = 0;
14946 (gdbslet) step
14947 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
14948 (gdbslet)
14949 @end smallexample
14950
14951 @node Sparclite
14952 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
14953
14954 @table @code
14955
14956 @kindex target sparclite
14957 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
14958 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
14959 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
14960 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
14961 remote protocol.
14962
14963 @end table
14964
14965 @node Z8000
14966 @subsection Zilog Z8000
14967
14968 @cindex Z8000
14969 @cindex simulator, Z8000
14970 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
14971
14972 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
14973 a Z8000 simulator.
14974
14975 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
14976 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
14977 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
14978 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
14979
14980 @table @code
14981 @item target sim @var{args}
14982 @kindex sim
14983 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
14984 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
14985 options, specify them via @var{args}.
14986 @end table
14987
14988 @noindent
14989 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
14990 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
14991 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
14992 to run your program, and so on.
14993
14994 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
14995 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
14996 additional items of information as specially named registers:
14997
14998 @table @code
14999
15000 @item cycles
15001 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15002
15003 @item insts
15004 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15005
15006 @item time
15007 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15008
15009 @end table
15010
15011 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15012 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15013 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15014 simulated clock ticks.
15015
15016 @node AVR
15017 @subsection Atmel AVR
15018 @cindex AVR
15019
15020 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15021 following AVR-specific commands:
15022
15023 @table @code
15024 @item info io_registers
15025 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15026 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15027 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15028 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15029 @end table
15030
15031 @node CRIS
15032 @subsection CRIS
15033 @cindex CRIS
15034
15035 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15036 following CRIS-specific commands:
15037
15038 @table @code
15039 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15040 @cindex CRIS version
15041 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15042 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15043 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15044
15045 @item show cris-version
15046 Show the current CRIS version.
15047
15048 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15049 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15050 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15051 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15052 @code{R59}.
15053
15054 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15055 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15056
15057 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15058 @cindex CRIS mode
15059 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15060 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15061 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15062
15063 @item show cris-mode
15064 Show the current CRIS mode.
15065 @end table
15066
15067 @node Super-H
15068 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15069 @cindex Super-H
15070
15071 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15072 commands:
15073
15074 @table @code
15075 @item regs
15076 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15077 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15078 @end table
15079
15080
15081 @node Architectures
15082 @section Architectures
15083
15084 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15085 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15086
15087 @menu
15088 * i386::
15089 * A29K::
15090 * Alpha::
15091 * MIPS::
15092 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15093 @end menu
15094
15095 @node i386
15096 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15097
15098 @table @code
15099 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15100 @kindex set struct-convention
15101 @cindex struct return convention
15102 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15103 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15104 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15105 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15106 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15107 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15108 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15109 be returned in a register.
15110
15111 @item show struct-convention
15112 @kindex show struct-convention
15113 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15114 from functions.
15115 @end table
15116
15117 @node A29K
15118 @subsection A29K
15119
15120 @table @code
15121
15122 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15123 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15124 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15125 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15126 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15127 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15128 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15129 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15130 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15131 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15132 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15133 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15134 hexadecimal.
15135
15136 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15137 @item show rstack_high_address
15138 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15139 processors.
15140
15141 @end table
15142
15143 @node Alpha
15144 @subsection Alpha
15145
15146 See the following section.
15147
15148 @node MIPS
15149 @subsection MIPS
15150
15151 @cindex stack on Alpha
15152 @cindex stack on MIPS
15153 @cindex Alpha stack
15154 @cindex MIPS stack
15155 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15156 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15157 find the beginning of a function.
15158
15159 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15160 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15161 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15162 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15163 commands:
15164
15165 @table @code
15166 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15167 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15168 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15169 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15170 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15171 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15172 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15173 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15174
15175 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15176 Display the current limit.
15177 @end table
15178
15179 @noindent
15180 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15181 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15182
15183 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15184 programs:
15185
15186 @table @code
15187 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15188 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15189 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15190 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15191 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15192
15193 @table @samp
15194 @item 32
15195 32-bit GP registers
15196 @item 64
15197 64-bit GP registers
15198 @item auto
15199 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15200 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15201 @end table
15202
15203 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15204 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15205 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15206
15207 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15208 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15209 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15210 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15211 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15212 (the default).
15213
15214 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15215 @kindex set mips abi
15216 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15217 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15218 values of @var{arg} are:
15219
15220 @table @samp
15221 @item auto
15222 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15223 default).
15224 @item o32
15225 @item o64
15226 @item n32
15227 @item n64
15228 @item eabi32
15229 @item eabi64
15230 @item auto
15231 @end table
15232
15233 @item show mips abi
15234 @kindex show mips abi
15235 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15236
15237 @item set mipsfpu
15238 @itemx show mipsfpu
15239 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15240
15241 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15242 @kindex set mips mask-address
15243 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15244 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15245 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15246 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15247 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15248
15249 @item show mips mask-address
15250 @kindex show mips mask-address
15251 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15252 not.
15253
15254 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15255 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15256 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15257 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15258 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15259 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15260
15261 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15262 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15263 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15264
15265 @item set debug mips
15266 @kindex set debug mips
15267 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15268 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15269
15270 @item show debug mips
15271 @kindex show debug mips
15272 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15273 @end table
15274
15275
15276 @node HPPA
15277 @subsection HPPA
15278 @cindex HPPA support
15279
15280 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15281 following special commands:
15282
15283 @table @code
15284 @item set debug hppa
15285 @kindex set debug hppa
15286 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15287 messages are to be displayed.
15288
15289 @item show debug hppa
15290 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15291
15292 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15293 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15294 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15295 given @var{address}.
15296
15297 @end table
15298
15299
15300 @node Controlling GDB
15301 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15302
15303 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15304 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15305 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15306 described here.
15307
15308 @menu
15309 * Prompt:: Prompt
15310 * Editing:: Command editing
15311 * Command History:: Command history
15312 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15313 * Numbers:: Numbers
15314 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15315 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15316 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15317 @end menu
15318
15319 @node Prompt
15320 @section Prompt
15321
15322 @cindex prompt
15323
15324 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15325 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15326 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15327 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15328 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15329 which one you are talking to.
15330
15331 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15332 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15333 or a prompt that does not.
15334
15335 @table @code
15336 @kindex set prompt
15337 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15338 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15339
15340 @kindex show prompt
15341 @item show prompt
15342 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15343 @end table
15344
15345 @node Editing
15346 @section Command Editing
15347 @cindex readline
15348 @cindex command line editing
15349
15350 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15351 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15352 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15353 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15354 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15355 debugging sessions.
15356
15357 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15358 command @code{set}.
15359
15360 @table @code
15361 @kindex set editing
15362 @cindex editing
15363 @item set editing
15364 @itemx set editing on
15365 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15366
15367 @item set editing off
15368 Disable command line editing.
15369
15370 @kindex show editing
15371 @item show editing
15372 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15373 @end table
15374
15375 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15376 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15377 encouraged to read that chapter.
15378
15379 @node Command History
15380 @section Command History
15381 @cindex command history
15382
15383 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15384 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15385 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15386 history facility.
15387
15388 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15389 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15390 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15391
15392 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15393 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15394 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15395 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15396 pressed on a line by itself.
15397
15398 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15399 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15400 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15401 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15402
15403 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15404 history.
15405
15406 @table @code
15407 @cindex history substitution
15408 @cindex history file
15409 @kindex set history filename
15410 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15411 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15412 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15413 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15414 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15415 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15416 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15417 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15418 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15419 is not set.
15420
15421 @cindex save command history
15422 @kindex set history save
15423 @item set history save
15424 @itemx set history save on
15425 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15426 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15427
15428 @item set history save off
15429 Stop recording command history in a file.
15430
15431 @cindex history size
15432 @kindex set history size
15433 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15434 @item set history size @var{size}
15435 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15436 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15437 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15438 @end table
15439
15440 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15441 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15442
15443 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15444 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15445 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15446 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15447 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15448 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15449 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15450 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15451
15452 The commands to control history expansion are:
15453
15454 @table @code
15455 @item set history expansion on
15456 @itemx set history expansion
15457 @kindex set history expansion
15458 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15459
15460 @item set history expansion off
15461 Disable history expansion.
15462
15463 @c @group
15464 @kindex show history
15465 @item show history
15466 @itemx show history filename
15467 @itemx show history save
15468 @itemx show history size
15469 @itemx show history expansion
15470 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15471 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15472 @c @end group
15473 @end table
15474
15475 @table @code
15476 @kindex show commands
15477 @cindex show last commands
15478 @cindex display command history
15479 @item show commands
15480 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15481
15482 @item show commands @var{n}
15483 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15484
15485 @item show commands +
15486 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15487 @end table
15488
15489 @node Screen Size
15490 @section Screen Size
15491 @cindex size of screen
15492 @cindex pauses in output
15493
15494 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15495 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15496 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15497 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15498 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15499 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15500 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15501 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15502
15503 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15504 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15505 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15506 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15507 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15508 width} commands:
15509
15510 @table @code
15511 @kindex set height
15512 @kindex set width
15513 @kindex show width
15514 @kindex show height
15515 @item set height @var{lpp}
15516 @itemx show height
15517 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15518 @itemx show width
15519 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15520 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15521 commands display the current settings.
15522
15523 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15524 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15525 file or to an editor buffer.
15526
15527 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15528 from wrapping its output.
15529
15530 @item set pagination on
15531 @itemx set pagination off
15532 @kindex set pagination
15533 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15534 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15535
15536 @item show pagination
15537 @kindex show pagination
15538 Show the current pagination mode.
15539 @end table
15540
15541 @node Numbers
15542 @section Numbers
15543 @cindex number representation
15544 @cindex entering numbers
15545
15546 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15547 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15548 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15549 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15550 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15551 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15552 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15553 both input and output with the commands described below.
15554
15555 @table @code
15556 @kindex set input-radix
15557 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15558 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15559 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15560 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15561 example, any of
15562
15563 @smallexample
15564 set input-radix 012
15565 set input-radix 10.
15566 set input-radix 0xa
15567 @end smallexample
15568
15569 @noindent
15570 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15571 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15572 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15573 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15574 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15575 change the radix.
15576
15577 @kindex set output-radix
15578 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15579 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15580 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15581 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15582
15583 @kindex show input-radix
15584 @item show input-radix
15585 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15586
15587 @kindex show output-radix
15588 @item show output-radix
15589 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15590
15591 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15592 @itemx show radix
15593 @kindex set radix
15594 @kindex show radix
15595 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15596 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15597 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15598 default value of 10.
15599
15600 @end table
15601
15602 @node ABI
15603 @section Configuring the Current ABI
15604
15605 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15606 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15607 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15608 current ABI.
15609
15610 @cindex OS ABI
15611 @kindex set osabi
15612 @kindex show osabi
15613
15614 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15615 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15616 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15617 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15618 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15619 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15620 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15621 platform provides.
15622
15623 @table @code
15624 @item show osabi
15625 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15626
15627 @item set osabi
15628 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15629
15630 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15631 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15632 @end table
15633
15634 @cindex float promotion
15635
15636 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15637 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15638 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15639 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15640 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15641 @code{double} and then passed.
15642
15643 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15644 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15645 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15646
15647 @table @code
15648 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15649 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15650 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15651 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15652 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15653
15654 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15655 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15656 functions.
15657
15658 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15659 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15660 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15661 @end table
15662
15663 @kindex set cp-abi
15664 @kindex show cp-abi
15665 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15666 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15667 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15668 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15669 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15670 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15671 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15672 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15673 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15674 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15675 ``auto''.
15676
15677 @table @code
15678 @item show cp-abi
15679 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15680
15681 @item set cp-abi
15682 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15683
15684 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15685 @itemx set cp-abi auto
15686 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15687 @end table
15688
15689 @node Messages/Warnings
15690 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
15691
15692 @cindex verbose operation
15693 @cindex optional warnings
15694 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15695 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15696 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15697 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15698
15699 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15700 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15701 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
15702
15703 @table @code
15704 @kindex set verbose
15705 @item set verbose on
15706 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15707
15708 @item set verbose off
15709 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15710
15711 @kindex show verbose
15712 @item show verbose
15713 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15714 @end table
15715
15716 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15717 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15718 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
15719 Symbol Files}).
15720
15721 @table @code
15722
15723 @kindex set complaints
15724 @item set complaints @var{limit}
15725 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
15726 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
15727 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
15728 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
15729
15730 @kindex show complaints
15731 @item show complaints
15732 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
15733
15734 @end table
15735
15736 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
15737 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
15738 you try to run a program which is already running:
15739
15740 @smallexample
15741 (@value{GDBP}) run
15742 The program being debugged has been started already.
15743 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
15744 @end smallexample
15745
15746 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
15747 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
15748
15749 @table @code
15750
15751 @kindex set confirm
15752 @cindex flinching
15753 @cindex confirmation
15754 @cindex stupid questions
15755 @item set confirm off
15756 Disables confirmation requests.
15757
15758 @item set confirm on
15759 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
15760
15761 @kindex show confirm
15762 @item show confirm
15763 Displays state of confirmation requests.
15764
15765 @end table
15766
15767 @cindex command tracing
15768 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
15769 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
15770 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
15771 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
15772
15773 @table @code
15774 @kindex set trace-commands
15775 @cindex command scripts, debugging
15776 @item set trace-commands on
15777 Enable command tracing.
15778 @item set trace-commands off
15779 Disable command tracing.
15780 @item show trace-commands
15781 Display the current state of command tracing.
15782 @end table
15783
15784 @node Debugging Output
15785 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
15786 @cindex optional debugging messages
15787
15788 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
15789 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
15790 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
15791 section documents those commands.
15792
15793 @table @code
15794 @kindex set exec-done-display
15795 @item set exec-done-display
15796 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
15797 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
15798 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
15799 @kindex show exec-done-display
15800 @item show exec-done-display
15801 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
15802 notification.
15803 @kindex set debug
15804 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
15805 @cindex architecture debugging info
15806 @item set debug arch
15807 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
15808 @kindex show debug
15809 @item show debug arch
15810 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
15811 @item set debug aix-thread
15812 @cindex AIX threads
15813 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
15814 module.
15815 @item show debug aix-thread
15816 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
15817 @item set debug event
15818 @cindex event debugging info
15819 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
15820 default is off.
15821 @item show debug event
15822 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
15823 info.
15824 @item set debug expression
15825 @cindex expression debugging info
15826 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
15827 expression parsing. The default is off.
15828 @item show debug expression
15829 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
15830 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
15831 @item set debug frame
15832 @cindex frame debugging info
15833 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
15834 default is off.
15835 @item show debug frame
15836 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
15837 info.
15838 @item set debug infrun
15839 @cindex inferior debugging info
15840 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
15841 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
15842 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
15843 @item show debug infrun
15844 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
15845 @item set debug lin-lwp
15846 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
15847 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
15848 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
15849 @item show debug lin-lwp
15850 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
15851 @item set debug observer
15852 @cindex observer debugging info
15853 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
15854 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
15855 @item show debug observer
15856 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
15857 @item set debug overload
15858 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
15859 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
15860 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
15861 is off.
15862 @item show debug overload
15863 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
15864 debugging info.
15865 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
15866 @cindex serial connections, debugging
15867 @cindex debug remote protocol
15868 @cindex remote protocol debugging
15869 @cindex display remote packets
15870 @item set debug remote
15871 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
15872 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
15873 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
15874 @item show debug remote
15875 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
15876 @item set debug serial
15877 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
15878 default is off.
15879 @item show debug serial
15880 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
15881 info.
15882 @item set debug solib-frv
15883 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
15884 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
15885 @item show debug solib-frv
15886 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
15887 messages.
15888 @item set debug target
15889 @cindex target debugging info
15890 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
15891 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
15892 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
15893 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
15894 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
15895 @item show debug target
15896 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
15897 info.
15898 @item set debugvarobj
15899 @cindex variable object debugging info
15900 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
15901 info. The default is off.
15902 @item show debugvarobj
15903 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
15904 debugging info.
15905 @item set debug xml
15906 @cindex XML parser debugging
15907 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
15908 @item show debug xml
15909 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
15910 @end table
15911
15912 @node Sequences
15913 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
15914
15915 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
15916 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
15917 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
15918 files.
15919
15920 @menu
15921 * Define:: How to define your own commands
15922 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
15923 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
15924 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
15925 @end menu
15926
15927 @node Define
15928 @section User-defined Commands
15929
15930 @cindex user-defined command
15931 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
15932 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
15933 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
15934 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
15935 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
15936 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
15937
15938 @smallexample
15939 define adder
15940 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
15941 end
15942 @end smallexample
15943
15944 @noindent
15945 To execute the command use:
15946
15947 @smallexample
15948 adder 1 2 3
15949 @end smallexample
15950
15951 @noindent
15952 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
15953 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
15954 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
15955 functions calls.
15956
15957 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
15958 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
15959 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
15960 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
15961
15962 @smallexample
15963 define adder
15964 if $argc == 2
15965 print $arg0 + $arg1
15966 end
15967 if $argc == 3
15968 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
15969 end
15970 end
15971 @end smallexample
15972
15973 @table @code
15974
15975 @kindex define
15976 @item define @var{commandname}
15977 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
15978 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
15979
15980 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
15981 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
15982 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
15983
15984 @kindex document
15985 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
15986 @item document @var{commandname}
15987 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
15988 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
15989 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
15990 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
15991 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
15992 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
15993
15994 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
15995 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
15996 does not change the documentation.
15997
15998 @kindex dont-repeat
15999 @cindex don't repeat command
16000 @item dont-repeat
16001 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16002 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16003 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16004
16005 @kindex help user-defined
16006 @item help user-defined
16007 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16008 (if any) for each.
16009
16010 @kindex show user
16011 @item show user
16012 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16013 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16014 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16015 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16016
16017 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16018 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16019 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16020 @item show max-user-call-depth
16021 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16022 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16023 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16024 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16025 @end table
16026
16027 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16028 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16029
16030 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16031 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16032 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16033
16034 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16035 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16036 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16037 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16038
16039 @node Hooks
16040 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16041 @cindex command hooks
16042 @cindex hooks, for commands
16043 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16044
16045 @kindex hook
16046 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16047 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16048 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16049 before that command.
16050
16051 @cindex hooks, post-command
16052 @kindex hookpost
16053 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16054 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16055 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16056 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16057 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16058
16059 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16060 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16061
16062 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16063 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16064
16065 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16066 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16067 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16068 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16069 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16070
16071 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16072 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16073 you could define:
16074
16075 @smallexample
16076 define hook-stop
16077 handle SIGALRM nopass
16078 end
16079
16080 define hook-run
16081 handle SIGALRM pass
16082 end
16083
16084 define hook-continue
16085 handle SIGALRM pass
16086 end
16087 @end smallexample
16088
16089 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16090 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16091 you could define:
16092
16093 @smallexample
16094 define hook-echo
16095 echo <<<---
16096 end
16097
16098 define hookpost-echo
16099 echo --->>>\n
16100 end
16101
16102 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16103 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16104 (@value{GDBP})
16105
16106 @end smallexample
16107
16108 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16109 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16110 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16111 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16112 @c or not?
16113 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16114 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16115 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16116
16117 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16118 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16119
16120 @node Command Files
16121 @section Command Files
16122
16123 @cindex command files
16124 @cindex scripting commands
16125 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16126 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16127 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16128 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16129 terminal.
16130
16131 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16132 command:
16133
16134 @table @code
16135 @kindex source
16136 @cindex execute commands from a file
16137 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16138 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16139 @end table
16140
16141 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16142 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16143 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16144 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16145 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16146
16147 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16148 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16149
16150 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16151 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16152 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16153
16154 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16155 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16156 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16157 when called from command files.
16158
16159 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16160 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16161 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16162 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16163 the next command.
16164
16165 @smallexample
16166 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16167 @end smallexample
16168
16169 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16170 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16171 would be directed to @file{log}.
16172
16173 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16174 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16175 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16176 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16177 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16178 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16179 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16180 conditionally, etc.
16181
16182 @table @code
16183 @kindex if
16184 @kindex else
16185 @item if
16186 @itemx else
16187 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16188 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16189 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16190 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16191 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16192 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16193 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16194
16195 @kindex while
16196 @item while
16197 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16198 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16199 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16200 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16201 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16202 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16203
16204 @kindex loop_break
16205 @item loop_break
16206 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16207 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16208 line.
16209
16210 @kindex loop_continue
16211 @item loop_continue
16212 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16213 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16214 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16215 the controlling expression.
16216
16217 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16218 @item end
16219 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16220 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16221 @end table
16222
16223
16224 @node Output
16225 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16226
16227 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16228 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16229 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16230 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16231 want.
16232
16233 @table @code
16234 @kindex echo
16235 @item echo @var{text}
16236 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16237 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16238 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16239 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16240 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16241 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16242 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16243 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16244 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16245 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16246 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16247
16248 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16249 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16250
16251 @smallexample
16252 echo This is some text\n\
16253 which is continued\n\
16254 onto several lines.\n
16255 @end smallexample
16256
16257 produces the same output as
16258
16259 @smallexample
16260 echo This is some text\n
16261 echo which is continued\n
16262 echo onto several lines.\n
16263 @end smallexample
16264
16265 @kindex output
16266 @item output @var{expression}
16267 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16268 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16269 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16270 on expressions.
16271
16272 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16273 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16274 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16275 Formats}, for more information.
16276
16277 @kindex printf
16278 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16279 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16280 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16281 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16282 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16283 subroutine
16284 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16285 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16286 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16287 @c supported.
16288
16289 @smallexample
16290 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16291 @end smallexample
16292
16293 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16294
16295 @smallexample
16296 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16297 @end smallexample
16298
16299 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16300 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16301 letter.
16302 @end table
16303
16304 @node Interpreters
16305 @chapter Command Interpreters
16306 @cindex command interpreters
16307
16308 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16309 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16310 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16311
16312 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16313 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16314 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16315 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16316
16317 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16318 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16319 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16320 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16321
16322 @table @code
16323 @item console
16324 @cindex console interpreter
16325 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16326 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16327 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16328
16329 @item mi
16330 @cindex mi interpreter
16331 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16332 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16333 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16334 Interface}.
16335
16336 @item mi2
16337 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16338 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16339
16340 @item mi1
16341 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16342 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16343
16344 @end table
16345
16346 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16347 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16348 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16349 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16350 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16351 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16352 the IDE inoperable!
16353
16354 @kindex interpreter-exec
16355 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16356 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16357 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16358 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16359
16360 @smallexample
16361 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16362 @end smallexample
16363
16364 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16365 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16366
16367 @node TUI
16368 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16369 @cindex TUI
16370 @cindex Text User Interface
16371
16372 @menu
16373 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16374 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16375 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16376 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16377 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16378 @end menu
16379
16380 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16381 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16382 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16383 commands in separate text windows.
16384
16385 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16386 @pindex gdbtui
16387 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16388
16389 @node TUI Overview
16390 @section TUI Overview
16391
16392 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16393 @value{GDBN} runs:
16394
16395 @itemize @bullet
16396 @item
16397 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16398 windows on the terminal.
16399
16400 @item
16401 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16402 the TUI.
16403 @end itemize
16404
16405 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16406 on the terminal:
16407
16408 @table @emph
16409 @item command
16410 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16411 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16412 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16413 window is always visible.
16414
16415 @item source
16416 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16417 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16418
16419 @item assembly
16420 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16421
16422 @item register
16423 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16424 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16425 changed are highlighted.
16426
16427 @end table
16428
16429 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16430 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16431 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16432 indicates the breakpoint type:
16433
16434 @table @code
16435 @item B
16436 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16437
16438 @item b
16439 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16440
16441 @item H
16442 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16443
16444 @item h
16445 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16446
16447 @end table
16448
16449 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16450
16451 @table @code
16452 @item +
16453 Breakpoint is enabled.
16454
16455 @item -
16456 Breakpoint is disabled.
16457
16458 @end table
16459
16460 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16461 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16462 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16463 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16464 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16465 The following layouts are available:
16466
16467 @itemize @bullet
16468 @item
16469 source
16470
16471 @item
16472 assembly
16473
16474 @item
16475 source and assembly
16476
16477 @item
16478 source and registers
16479
16480 @item
16481 assembly and registers
16482
16483 @end itemize
16484
16485 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16486 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16487 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16488 are displayed:
16489
16490 @table @emph
16491 @item target
16492 Indicates the current gdb target
16493 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16494
16495 @item process
16496 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16497 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16498
16499 @item function
16500 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16501 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16502 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16503 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16504
16505 @item line
16506 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16507 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16508
16509 @item pc
16510 Indicates the current program counter address.
16511
16512 @end table
16513
16514 @node TUI Keys
16515 @section TUI Key Bindings
16516 @cindex TUI key bindings
16517
16518 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16519 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16520 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16521 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16522 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16523 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16524 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16525
16526 @table @kbd
16527 @kindex C-x C-a
16528 @item C-x C-a
16529 @kindex C-x a
16530 @itemx C-x a
16531 @kindex C-x A
16532 @itemx C-x A
16533 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16534 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16535 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16536 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16537 The screen is then refreshed.
16538
16539 @kindex C-x 1
16540 @item C-x 1
16541 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16542 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16543 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16544
16545 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16546
16547 @kindex C-x 2
16548 @item C-x 2
16549 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16550 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16551 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16552 previous layout and the new one.
16553
16554 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16555
16556 @kindex C-x o
16557 @item C-x o
16558 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16559 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16560 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16561
16562 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16563
16564 @kindex C-x s
16565 @item C-x s
16566 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16567 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16568
16569 @end table
16570
16571 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16572
16573 @table @key
16574 @kindex PgUp
16575 @item PgUp
16576 Scroll the active window one page up.
16577
16578 @kindex PgDn
16579 @item PgDn
16580 Scroll the active window one page down.
16581
16582 @kindex Up
16583 @item Up
16584 Scroll the active window one line up.
16585
16586 @kindex Down
16587 @item Down
16588 Scroll the active window one line down.
16589
16590 @kindex Left
16591 @item Left
16592 Scroll the active window one column left.
16593
16594 @kindex Right
16595 @item Right
16596 Scroll the active window one column right.
16597
16598 @kindex C-L
16599 @item C-L
16600 Refresh the screen.
16601
16602 @end table
16603
16604 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16605 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16606 active window is the command window. When the command window
16607 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16608 key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} and @kbd{C-f}.
16609
16610 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16611 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16612 @cindex TUI single key mode
16613
16614 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16615 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16616 some gdb commands.
16617
16618 @table @kbd
16619 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16620 @item c
16621 continue
16622
16623 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16624 @item d
16625 down
16626
16627 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16628 @item f
16629 finish
16630
16631 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16632 @item n
16633 next
16634
16635 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16636 @item q
16637 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16638
16639 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16640 @item r
16641 run
16642
16643 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16644 @item s
16645 step
16646
16647 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16648 @item u
16649 up
16650
16651 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16652 @item v
16653 info locals
16654
16655 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16656 @item w
16657 where
16658
16659 @end table
16660
16661 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16662 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16663 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16664 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16665 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16666 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
16667
16668
16669 @node TUI Commands
16670 @section TUI-specific Commands
16671 @cindex TUI commands
16672
16673 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16674 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
16675 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
16676 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
16677 in the TUI mode.
16678
16679 @table @code
16680 @item info win
16681 @kindex info win
16682 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16683
16684 @item layout next
16685 @kindex layout
16686 Display the next layout.
16687
16688 @item layout prev
16689 Display the previous layout.
16690
16691 @item layout src
16692 Display the source window only.
16693
16694 @item layout asm
16695 Display the assembly window only.
16696
16697 @item layout split
16698 Display the source and assembly window.
16699
16700 @item layout regs
16701 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
16702
16703 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
16704 @kindex focus
16705 Set the focus to the named window.
16706 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
16707 can be affected to another window.
16708
16709 @item refresh
16710 @kindex refresh
16711 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
16712
16713 @item tui reg float
16714 @kindex tui reg
16715 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
16716
16717 @item tui reg general
16718 Show the general registers in the register window.
16719
16720 @item tui reg next
16721 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
16722 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
16723 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
16724 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
16725
16726 @item tui reg system
16727 Show the system registers in the register window.
16728
16729 @item update
16730 @kindex update
16731 Update the source window and the current execution point.
16732
16733 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
16734 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
16735 @kindex winheight
16736 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
16737 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
16738 decrease it.
16739
16740 @item tabset
16741 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
16742 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
16743
16744 @end table
16745
16746 @node TUI Configuration
16747 @section TUI Configuration Variables
16748 @cindex TUI configuration variables
16749
16750 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
16751 appearance of windows on the terminal.
16752
16753 @table @code
16754 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
16755 @kindex set tui border-kind
16756 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
16757 The possible values are the following:
16758 @table @code
16759 @item space
16760 Use a space character to draw the border.
16761
16762 @item ascii
16763 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
16764
16765 @item acs
16766 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
16767 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
16768
16769 @end table
16770
16771 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
16772 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
16773 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
16774 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
16775 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
16776
16777 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
16778 @kindex set tui border-mode
16779 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
16780 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
16781 @table @code
16782 @item normal
16783 Use normal attributes to display the border.
16784
16785 @item standout
16786 Use standout mode.
16787
16788 @item reverse
16789 Use reverse video mode.
16790
16791 @item half
16792 Use half bright mode.
16793
16794 @item half-standout
16795 Use half bright and standout mode.
16796
16797 @item bold
16798 Use extra bright or bold mode.
16799
16800 @item bold-standout
16801 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
16802
16803 @end table
16804
16805 @end table
16806
16807 @node Emacs
16808 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
16809
16810 @cindex Emacs
16811 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
16812 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
16813 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
16814 @value{GDBN}.
16815
16816 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
16817 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
16818 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
16819 created Emacs buffer.
16820 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
16821
16822 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
16823 things:
16824
16825 @itemize @bullet
16826 @item
16827 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
16828 @end itemize
16829
16830 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
16831 and output done by the program you are debugging.
16832
16833 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
16834 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
16835 in this way.
16836
16837 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
16838 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
16839 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
16840 stop.
16841
16842 @itemize @bullet
16843 @item
16844 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
16845 @end itemize
16846
16847 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
16848 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
16849 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
16850 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
16851 and the source.
16852
16853 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
16854 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
16855
16856 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
16857 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
16858 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
16859 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
16860 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
16861 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
16862 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
16863 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
16864 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
16865
16866 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
16867 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
16868 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
16869 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16870
16871 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
16872 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
16873 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
16874 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
16875 one you want.
16876
16877 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
16878 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
16879
16880 @table @kbd
16881 @item C-h m
16882 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
16883
16884 @item C-c C-s
16885 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
16886 update the display window to show the current file and location.
16887
16888 @item C-c C-n
16889 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
16890 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
16891 to show the current file and location.
16892
16893 @item C-c C-i
16894 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
16895 display window accordingly.
16896
16897 @item C-c C-f
16898 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
16899 @code{finish} command.
16900
16901 @item C-c C-r
16902 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
16903 command.
16904
16905 @item C-c <
16906 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
16907 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
16908 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
16909
16910 @item C-c >
16911 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
16912 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
16913 @end table
16914
16915 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
16916 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
16917
16918 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
16919 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
16920 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
16921 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
16922 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
16923 current one.
16924
16925 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
16926 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
16927 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
16928 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
16929 frame.
16930
16931 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
16932 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
16933 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
16934 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
16935 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
16936 to correspond properly with the code.
16937
16938 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
16939 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
16940 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
16941
16942 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
16943 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
16944 @ignore
16945 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
16946 @kindex Epoch
16947 @kindex inspect
16948
16949 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
16950 called the @code{epoch}
16951 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
16952 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
16953 each value is printed in its own window.
16954 @end ignore
16955
16956
16957 @node GDB/MI
16958 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
16959
16960 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
16961
16962 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
16963 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
16964 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
16965 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
16966 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
16967 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
16968
16969 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
16970 in the form of a reference manual.
16971
16972 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
16973 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
16974 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
16975
16976 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
16977
16978 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
16979 This chapter uses the following notation:
16980
16981 @itemize @bullet
16982 @item
16983 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
16984
16985 @item
16986 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
16987 it may or may not be given.
16988
16989 @item
16990 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
16991 may repeat zero or more times.
16992
16993 @item
16994 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
16995 may repeat one or more times.
16996
16997 @item
16998 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
16999 @end itemize
17000
17001 @ignore
17002 @heading Dependencies
17003 @end ignore
17004
17005 @menu
17006 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17007 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17008 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17009 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17010 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17011 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17012 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17013 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17014 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17015 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17016 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17017 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17018 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17019 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17020 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17021 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17022 @ignore
17023 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17024 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17025 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17026 @end ignore
17027 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17028 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17029 @end menu
17030
17031 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17032 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17033 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17034
17035 @menu
17036 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17037 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17038 @end menu
17039
17040 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17041 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17042
17043 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17044 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17045 @table @code
17046 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17047 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17048
17049 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17050 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17051 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17052
17053 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17054 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17055 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17056
17057 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17058 "any sequence of digits"
17059
17060 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17061 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17062
17063 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17064 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17065
17066 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17067 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17068
17069 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17070 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17071 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17072
17073 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17074 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17075
17076 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17077 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17078 @end table
17079
17080 @noindent
17081 Notes:
17082
17083 @itemize @bullet
17084 @item
17085 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17086 output is described below.
17087
17088 @item
17089 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17090 finishes.
17091
17092 @item
17093 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17094 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17095 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17096 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17097 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17098 @end itemize
17099
17100 Pragmatics:
17101
17102 @itemize @bullet
17103 @item
17104 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17105
17106 @item
17107 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17108 @end itemize
17109
17110 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17111 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17112
17113 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17114 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17115 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17116 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17117 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17118 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17119
17120 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17121 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17122 @var{token}.
17123
17124 @table @code
17125 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17126 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17127
17128 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17129 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17130
17131 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17132 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17133
17134 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17135 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17136
17137 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17138 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17139
17140 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17141 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17142
17143 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17144 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17145
17146 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17147 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17148
17149 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17150 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17151
17152 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17153 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17154 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17155
17156 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17157 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17158
17159 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17160 @code{ @var{string} }
17161
17162 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17163 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17164
17165 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17166 @code{@var{c-string}}
17167
17168 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17169 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17170
17171 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17172 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17173 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17174
17175 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17176 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17177
17178 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17179 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17180
17181 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17182 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17183
17184 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17185 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17186
17187 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17188 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17189
17190 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17191 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17192 @end table
17193
17194 @noindent
17195 Notes:
17196
17197 @itemize @bullet
17198 @item
17199 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17200
17201 @item
17202 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17203 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17204 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17205 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17206
17207 @item
17208 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17209 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17210 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17211 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17212
17213 @item
17214 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17215 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17216 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17217 @samp{*}.
17218
17219 @item
17220 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17221 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17222 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17223 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17224
17225 @item
17226 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17227 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17228 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17229 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17230
17231 @item
17232 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17233 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17234 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17235
17236 @item
17237 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17238 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17239 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17240 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17241
17242 @item
17243 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17244 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17245 @var{values}.
17246
17247
17248 @end itemize
17249
17250 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17251 details about the various output records.
17252
17253 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17254 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17255 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17256
17257 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17258 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17259
17260 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17261 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17262 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17263 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17264 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17265 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17266
17267 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17268 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17269 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17270
17271 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17272 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17273 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17274 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17275
17276 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17277 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17278
17279 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17280 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17281 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17282 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17283 might change.
17284
17285 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17286 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17287 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17288 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17289
17290 @itemize @bullet
17291 @item
17292 New MI commands may be added.
17293
17294 @item
17295 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17296
17297 @item
17298 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17299 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update-fields}) may be extended.
17300
17301 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17302 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17303
17304 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17305 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17306 @end itemize
17307
17308 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17309 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17310 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17311 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17312 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17313
17314 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17315 @c version?
17316
17317 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17318 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17319 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17320 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17321 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17322 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17323 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17324 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17325 @cindex mailing lists
17326
17327 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17328 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17329 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17330
17331 @menu
17332 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17333 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17334 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17335 @end menu
17336
17337 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17338 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17339
17340 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17341 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17342 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17343 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17344
17345 @table @code
17346 @findex ^done
17347 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17348 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17349 values.
17350
17351 @item "^running"
17352 @findex ^running
17353 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17354 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17355 running.
17356
17357 @item "^connected"
17358 @findex ^connected
17359 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17360
17361 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17362 @findex ^error
17363 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17364 error message.
17365
17366 @item "^exit"
17367 @findex ^exit
17368 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17369
17370 @end table
17371
17372 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17373 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17374
17375 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17376 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17377 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17378 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17379 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17380
17381 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17382 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17383 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17384 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17385 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17386
17387 @table @code
17388 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17389 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17390 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17391
17392 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17393 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17394 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17395 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17396
17397 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17398 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17399 internals.
17400 @end table
17401
17402 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17403 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17404
17405 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17406 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17407 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17408 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17409 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17410 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17411
17412 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17413 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17414
17415 @table @code
17416 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17417 @end table
17418
17419 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17420
17421 @table @code
17422 @item breakpoint-hit
17423 A breakpoint was reached.
17424 @item watchpoint-trigger
17425 A watchpoint was triggered.
17426 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17427 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17428 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17429 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17430 @item function-finished
17431 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17432 @item location-reached
17433 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17434 @item watchpoint-scope
17435 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17436 @item end-stepping-range
17437 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17438 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17439 @item exited-signalled
17440 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17441 @item exited
17442 The inferior exited.
17443 @item exited-normally
17444 The inferior exited normally.
17445 @item signal-received
17446 A signal was received by the inferior.
17447 @end table
17448
17449
17450 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17451 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17452 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17453 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17454
17455 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17456 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17457 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17458 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17459
17460 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17461 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17462
17463 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17464
17465 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17466 information of the breakpoint.
17467
17468 @smallexample
17469 -> -break-insert main
17470 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17471 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17472 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17473 <- (gdb)
17474 @end smallexample
17475
17476 @subheading Program Execution
17477
17478 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17479 reason that execution stopped.
17480
17481 @smallexample
17482 -> -exec-run
17483 <- ^running
17484 <- (gdb)
17485 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17486 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17487 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17488 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17489 <- (gdb)
17490 -> -exec-continue
17491 <- ^running
17492 <- (gdb)
17493 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17494 <- (gdb)
17495 @end smallexample
17496
17497 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
17498
17499 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17500
17501 @smallexample
17502 -> (gdb)
17503 <- -gdb-exit
17504 <- ^exit
17505 @end smallexample
17506
17507 @subheading A Bad Command
17508
17509 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17510
17511 @smallexample
17512 -> -rubbish
17513 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17514 <- (gdb)
17515 @end smallexample
17516
17517
17518 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17519 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17520 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17521
17522 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17523 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17524
17525 @subheading Motivation
17526
17527 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17528
17529 @subheading Introduction
17530
17531 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17532
17533 @subheading Commands
17534
17535 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17536
17537 @subsubheading Synopsis
17538
17539 @smallexample
17540 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17541 @end smallexample
17542
17543 @subsubheading Result
17544
17545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17546
17547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17548
17549 @subsubheading Example
17550
17551 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17552 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17553
17554
17555 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17556 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17557 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17558
17559 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17560 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17561 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17562 breakpoints.
17563
17564 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17565 @findex -break-after
17566
17567 @subsubheading Synopsis
17568
17569 @smallexample
17570 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17571 @end smallexample
17572
17573 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17574 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17575 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17576 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17577
17578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17579
17580 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17581
17582 @subsubheading Example
17583
17584 @smallexample
17585 (gdb)
17586 -break-insert main
17587 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17588 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17589 (gdb)
17590 -break-after 1 3
17591 ~
17592 ^done
17593 (gdb)
17594 -break-list
17595 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17596 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17597 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17598 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17599 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17600 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17601 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17602 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17603 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17604 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17605 (gdb)
17606 @end smallexample
17607
17608 @ignore
17609 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17610 @findex -break-catch
17611
17612 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17613 @findex -break-commands
17614 @end ignore
17615
17616
17617 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17618 @findex -break-condition
17619
17620 @subsubheading Synopsis
17621
17622 @smallexample
17623 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17624 @end smallexample
17625
17626 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17627 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17628 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17629 command below).
17630
17631 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17632
17633 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17634
17635 @subsubheading Example
17636
17637 @smallexample
17638 (gdb)
17639 -break-condition 1 1
17640 ^done
17641 (gdb)
17642 -break-list
17643 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17644 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17645 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17646 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17647 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17648 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17649 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17650 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17651 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17652 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17653 (gdb)
17654 @end smallexample
17655
17656 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17657 @findex -break-delete
17658
17659 @subsubheading Synopsis
17660
17661 @smallexample
17662 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17663 @end smallexample
17664
17665 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17666 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17667
17668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17669
17670 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17671
17672 @subsubheading Example
17673
17674 @smallexample
17675 (gdb)
17676 -break-delete 1
17677 ^done
17678 (gdb)
17679 -break-list
17680 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17681 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17682 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17683 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17684 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17685 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17686 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17687 body=[]@}
17688 (gdb)
17689 @end smallexample
17690
17691 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
17692 @findex -break-disable
17693
17694 @subsubheading Synopsis
17695
17696 @smallexample
17697 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17698 @end smallexample
17699
17700 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
17701 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
17702
17703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17704
17705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
17706
17707 @subsubheading Example
17708
17709 @smallexample
17710 (gdb)
17711 -break-disable 2
17712 ^done
17713 (gdb)
17714 -break-list
17715 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17716 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17717 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17718 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17719 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17720 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17721 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17722 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
17723 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17724 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17725 (gdb)
17726 @end smallexample
17727
17728 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
17729 @findex -break-enable
17730
17731 @subsubheading Synopsis
17732
17733 @smallexample
17734 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17735 @end smallexample
17736
17737 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
17738
17739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17740
17741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
17742
17743 @subsubheading Example
17744
17745 @smallexample
17746 (gdb)
17747 -break-enable 2
17748 ^done
17749 (gdb)
17750 -break-list
17751 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17752 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17753 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17754 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17755 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17756 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17757 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17758 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17759 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17760 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17761 (gdb)
17762 @end smallexample
17763
17764 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
17765 @findex -break-info
17766
17767 @subsubheading Synopsis
17768
17769 @smallexample
17770 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
17771 @end smallexample
17772
17773 @c REDUNDANT???
17774 Get information about a single breakpoint.
17775
17776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17777
17778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
17779
17780 @subsubheading Example
17781 N.A.
17782
17783 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
17784 @findex -break-insert
17785
17786 @subsubheading Synopsis
17787
17788 @smallexample
17789 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
17790 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
17791 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
17792 @end smallexample
17793
17794 @noindent
17795 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
17796
17797 @itemize @bullet
17798 @item function
17799 @c @item +offset
17800 @c @item -offset
17801 @c @item linenum
17802 @item filename:linenum
17803 @item filename:function
17804 @item *address
17805 @end itemize
17806
17807 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
17808
17809 @table @samp
17810 @item -t
17811 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
17812 @item -h
17813 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
17814 @item -c @var{condition}
17815 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
17816 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
17817 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
17818 @item -r
17819 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
17820 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
17821 expressions.
17822 @end table
17823
17824 @subsubheading Result
17825
17826 The result is in the form:
17827
17828 @smallexample
17829 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
17830 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
17831 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
17832 times="@var{times}"@}
17833 @end smallexample
17834
17835 @noindent
17836 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
17837 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
17838 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
17839 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
17840 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
17841 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
17842 which use the same output).
17843
17844 Note: this format is open to change.
17845 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
17846
17847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17848
17849 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
17850 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
17851
17852 @subsubheading Example
17853
17854 @smallexample
17855 (gdb)
17856 -break-insert main
17857 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
17858 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
17859 (gdb)
17860 -break-insert -t foo
17861 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
17862 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
17863 (gdb)
17864 -break-list
17865 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17866 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17867 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17868 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17869 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17870 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17871 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17872 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17873 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
17874 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
17875 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
17876 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
17877 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
17878 (gdb)
17879 -break-insert -r foo.*
17880 ~int foo(int, int);
17881 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
17882 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
17883 (gdb)
17884 @end smallexample
17885
17886 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
17887 @findex -break-list
17888
17889 @subsubheading Synopsis
17890
17891 @smallexample
17892 -break-list
17893 @end smallexample
17894
17895 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
17896
17897 @table @samp
17898 @item Number
17899 number of the breakpoint
17900 @item Type
17901 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
17902 @item Disposition
17903 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
17904 or @samp{nokeep}
17905 @item Enabled
17906 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
17907 @item Address
17908 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
17909 @item What
17910 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
17911 name, line number
17912 @item Times
17913 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
17914 @end table
17915
17916 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
17917 @code{body} field is an empty list.
17918
17919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17920
17921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
17922
17923 @subsubheading Example
17924
17925 @smallexample
17926 (gdb)
17927 -break-list
17928 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17929 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17930 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17931 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17932 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17933 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17934 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17935 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17936 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
17937 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17938 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17939 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
17940 (gdb)
17941 @end smallexample
17942
17943 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
17944
17945 @smallexample
17946 (gdb)
17947 -break-list
17948 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17949 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17950 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17951 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17952 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17953 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17954 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17955 body=[]@}
17956 (gdb)
17957 @end smallexample
17958
17959 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
17960 @findex -break-watch
17961
17962 @subsubheading Synopsis
17963
17964 @smallexample
17965 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
17966 @end smallexample
17967
17968 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
17969 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
17970 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
17971 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
17972 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
17973 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
17974 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
17975 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
17976
17977 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
17978 breakpoints inserted.
17979
17980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17981
17982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
17983 @samp{rwatch}.
17984
17985 @subsubheading Example
17986
17987 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
17988
17989 @smallexample
17990 (gdb)
17991 -break-watch x
17992 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
17993 (gdb)
17994 -exec-continue
17995 ^running
17996 (gdb)
17997 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
17998 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
17999 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18000 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18001 (gdb)
18002 @end smallexample
18003
18004 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18005 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18006 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18007
18008 @smallexample
18009 (gdb)
18010 -break-watch C
18011 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18012 (gdb)
18013 -exec-continue
18014 ^running
18015 (gdb)
18016 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18017 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18018 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18019 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18020 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18021 (gdb)
18022 -exec-continue
18023 ^running
18024 (gdb)
18025 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18026 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18027 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18028 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18029 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18030 (gdb)
18031 @end smallexample
18032
18033 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18034 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18035 deleted.
18036
18037 @smallexample
18038 (gdb)
18039 -break-watch C
18040 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18041 (gdb)
18042 -break-list
18043 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18044 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18045 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18046 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18047 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18048 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18049 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18050 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18051 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18052 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18053 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18054 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18055 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18056 (gdb)
18057 -exec-continue
18058 ^running
18059 (gdb)
18060 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18061 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18062 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18063 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18064 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18065 (gdb)
18066 -break-list
18067 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18068 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18069 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18070 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18071 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18072 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18073 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18074 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18075 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18076 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18077 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18078 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18079 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18080 (gdb)
18081 -exec-continue
18082 ^running
18083 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18084 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18085 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18086 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18087 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18088 (gdb)
18089 -break-list
18090 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18091 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18092 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18093 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18094 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18095 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18096 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18097 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18098 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18099 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18100 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18101 times="1"@}]@}
18102 (gdb)
18103 @end smallexample
18104
18105 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18106 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18107 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18108
18109 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18110 @findex -exec-arguments
18111
18112
18113 @subsubheading Synopsis
18114
18115 @smallexample
18116 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18117 @end smallexample
18118
18119 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18120 @samp{-exec-run}.
18121
18122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18123
18124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18125
18126 @subsubheading Example
18127
18128 @c FIXME!
18129 Don't have one around.
18130
18131
18132 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18133 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18134
18135 @subsubheading Synopsis
18136
18137 @smallexample
18138 -exec-show-arguments
18139 @end smallexample
18140
18141 Print the arguments of the program.
18142
18143 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18144
18145 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18146
18147 @subsubheading Example
18148 N.A.
18149
18150
18151 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18152 @findex -environment-cd
18153
18154 @subsubheading Synopsis
18155
18156 @smallexample
18157 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18158 @end smallexample
18159
18160 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18161
18162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18163
18164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18165
18166 @subsubheading Example
18167
18168 @smallexample
18169 (gdb)
18170 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18171 ^done
18172 (gdb)
18173 @end smallexample
18174
18175
18176 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18177 @findex -environment-directory
18178
18179 @subsubheading Synopsis
18180
18181 @smallexample
18182 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18183 @end smallexample
18184
18185 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18186 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18187 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18188 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18189 occurs as normal.
18190 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18191 multiple directories in a single command
18192 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18193 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18194 If blanks are needed as
18195 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18196 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18197 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18198 character must not be used
18199 in any directory name.
18200 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18201
18202 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18203
18204 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18205
18206 @subsubheading Example
18207
18208 @smallexample
18209 (gdb)
18210 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18211 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18212 (gdb)
18213 -environment-directory ""
18214 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18215 (gdb)
18216 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18217 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18218 (gdb)
18219 -environment-directory -r
18220 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18221 (gdb)
18222 @end smallexample
18223
18224
18225 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18226 @findex -environment-path
18227
18228 @subsubheading Synopsis
18229
18230 @smallexample
18231 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18232 @end smallexample
18233
18234 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18235 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18236 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18237 supplied in addition to the
18238 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18239 occurs as normal.
18240 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18241 multiple directories in a single command
18242 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18243 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18244 If blanks are needed as
18245 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18246 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18247 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18248 character must not be used
18249 in any directory name.
18250 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18251
18252
18253 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18254
18255 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18256
18257 @subsubheading Example
18258
18259 @smallexample
18260 (gdb)
18261 -environment-path
18262 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18263 (gdb)
18264 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18265 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18266 (gdb)
18267 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18268 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18269 (gdb)
18270 @end smallexample
18271
18272
18273 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18274 @findex -environment-pwd
18275
18276 @subsubheading Synopsis
18277
18278 @smallexample
18279 -environment-pwd
18280 @end smallexample
18281
18282 Show the current working directory.
18283
18284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18285
18286 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18287
18288 @subsubheading Example
18289
18290 @smallexample
18291 (gdb)
18292 -environment-pwd
18293 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18294 (gdb)
18295 @end smallexample
18296
18297 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18298 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18299 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18300
18301
18302 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18303 @findex -thread-info
18304
18305 @subsubheading Synopsis
18306
18307 @smallexample
18308 -thread-info
18309 @end smallexample
18310
18311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18312
18313 No equivalent.
18314
18315 @subsubheading Example
18316 N.A.
18317
18318
18319 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18320 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18321
18322 @subsubheading Synopsis
18323
18324 @smallexample
18325 -thread-list-all-threads
18326 @end smallexample
18327
18328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18329
18330 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18331
18332 @subsubheading Example
18333 N.A.
18334
18335
18336 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18337 @findex -thread-list-ids
18338
18339 @subsubheading Synopsis
18340
18341 @smallexample
18342 -thread-list-ids
18343 @end smallexample
18344
18345 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18346 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18347
18348 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18349
18350 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18351
18352 @subsubheading Example
18353
18354 No threads present, besides the main process:
18355
18356 @smallexample
18357 (gdb)
18358 -thread-list-ids
18359 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18360 (gdb)
18361 @end smallexample
18362
18363
18364 Several threads:
18365
18366 @smallexample
18367 (gdb)
18368 -thread-list-ids
18369 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18370 number-of-threads="3"
18371 (gdb)
18372 @end smallexample
18373
18374
18375 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18376 @findex -thread-select
18377
18378 @subsubheading Synopsis
18379
18380 @smallexample
18381 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18382 @end smallexample
18383
18384 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18385 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18386
18387 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18388
18389 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18390
18391 @subsubheading Example
18392
18393 @smallexample
18394 (gdb)
18395 -exec-next
18396 ^running
18397 (gdb)
18398 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18399 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18400 (gdb)
18401 -thread-list-ids
18402 ^done,
18403 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18404 number-of-threads="3"
18405 (gdb)
18406 -thread-select 3
18407 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18408 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18409 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18410 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18411 (gdb)
18412 @end smallexample
18413
18414 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18415 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18416 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18417
18418 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18419 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18420 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18421 other cases.
18422
18423 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18424 @findex -exec-continue
18425
18426 @subsubheading Synopsis
18427
18428 @smallexample
18429 -exec-continue
18430 @end smallexample
18431
18432 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18433 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18434
18435 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18436
18437 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18438
18439 @subsubheading Example
18440
18441 @smallexample
18442 -exec-continue
18443 ^running
18444 (gdb)
18445 @@Hello world
18446 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18447 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18448 (gdb)
18449 @end smallexample
18450
18451
18452 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18453 @findex -exec-finish
18454
18455 @subsubheading Synopsis
18456
18457 @smallexample
18458 -exec-finish
18459 @end smallexample
18460
18461 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18462 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18463
18464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18465
18466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18467
18468 @subsubheading Example
18469
18470 Function returning @code{void}.
18471
18472 @smallexample
18473 -exec-finish
18474 ^running
18475 (gdb)
18476 @@hello from foo
18477 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18478 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18479 (gdb)
18480 @end smallexample
18481
18482 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18483 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18484 value itself.
18485
18486 @smallexample
18487 -exec-finish
18488 ^running
18489 (gdb)
18490 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18491 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18492 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18493 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18494 (gdb)
18495 @end smallexample
18496
18497
18498 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18499 @findex -exec-interrupt
18500
18501 @subsubheading Synopsis
18502
18503 @smallexample
18504 -exec-interrupt
18505 @end smallexample
18506
18507 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18508 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18509 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18510 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18511 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18512
18513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18514
18515 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18516
18517 @subsubheading Example
18518
18519 @smallexample
18520 (gdb)
18521 111-exec-continue
18522 111^running
18523
18524 (gdb)
18525 222-exec-interrupt
18526 222^done
18527 (gdb)
18528 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18529 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18530 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18531 (gdb)
18532
18533 (gdb)
18534 -exec-interrupt
18535 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18536 (gdb)
18537 @end smallexample
18538
18539
18540 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18541 @findex -exec-next
18542
18543 @subsubheading Synopsis
18544
18545 @smallexample
18546 -exec-next
18547 @end smallexample
18548
18549 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18550 of the next source line is reached.
18551
18552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18553
18554 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18555
18556 @subsubheading Example
18557
18558 @smallexample
18559 -exec-next
18560 ^running
18561 (gdb)
18562 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18563 (gdb)
18564 @end smallexample
18565
18566
18567 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18568 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18569
18570 @subsubheading Synopsis
18571
18572 @smallexample
18573 -exec-next-instruction
18574 @end smallexample
18575
18576 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18577 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18578 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18579 printed as well.
18580
18581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18582
18583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18584
18585 @subsubheading Example
18586
18587 @smallexample
18588 (gdb)
18589 -exec-next-instruction
18590 ^running
18591
18592 (gdb)
18593 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18594 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18595 (gdb)
18596 @end smallexample
18597
18598
18599 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18600 @findex -exec-return
18601
18602 @subsubheading Synopsis
18603
18604 @smallexample
18605 -exec-return
18606 @end smallexample
18607
18608 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18609 Displays the new current frame.
18610
18611 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18612
18613 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18614
18615 @subsubheading Example
18616
18617 @smallexample
18618 (gdb)
18619 200-break-insert callee4
18620 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18621 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18622 (gdb)
18623 000-exec-run
18624 000^running
18625 (gdb)
18626 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18627 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18628 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18629 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18630 (gdb)
18631 205-break-delete
18632 205^done
18633 (gdb)
18634 111-exec-return
18635 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18636 args=[@{name="strarg",
18637 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18638 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18639 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18640 (gdb)
18641 @end smallexample
18642
18643
18644 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18645 @findex -exec-run
18646
18647 @subsubheading Synopsis
18648
18649 @smallexample
18650 -exec-run
18651 @end smallexample
18652
18653 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18654 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18655 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18656 the program has exited exceptionally.
18657
18658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18659
18660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18661
18662 @subsubheading Examples
18663
18664 @smallexample
18665 (gdb)
18666 -break-insert main
18667 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18668 (gdb)
18669 -exec-run
18670 ^running
18671 (gdb)
18672 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18673 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18674 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18675 (gdb)
18676 @end smallexample
18677
18678 @noindent
18679 Program exited normally:
18680
18681 @smallexample
18682 (gdb)
18683 -exec-run
18684 ^running
18685 (gdb)
18686 x = 55
18687 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18688 (gdb)
18689 @end smallexample
18690
18691 @noindent
18692 Program exited exceptionally:
18693
18694 @smallexample
18695 (gdb)
18696 -exec-run
18697 ^running
18698 (gdb)
18699 x = 55
18700 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
18701 (gdb)
18702 @end smallexample
18703
18704 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
18705 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
18706
18707 @smallexample
18708 (gdb)
18709 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
18710 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
18711 @end smallexample
18712
18713
18714 @c @subheading -exec-signal
18715
18716
18717 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
18718 @findex -exec-step
18719
18720 @subsubheading Synopsis
18721
18722 @smallexample
18723 -exec-step
18724 @end smallexample
18725
18726 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18727 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
18728 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
18729 function.
18730
18731 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18732
18733 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
18734
18735 @subsubheading Example
18736
18737 Stepping into a function:
18738
18739 @smallexample
18740 -exec-step
18741 ^running
18742 (gdb)
18743 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18744 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
18745 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
18746 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
18747 (gdb)
18748 @end smallexample
18749
18750 Regular stepping:
18751
18752 @smallexample
18753 -exec-step
18754 ^running
18755 (gdb)
18756 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
18757 (gdb)
18758 @end smallexample
18759
18760
18761 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
18762 @findex -exec-step-instruction
18763
18764 @subsubheading Synopsis
18765
18766 @smallexample
18767 -exec-step-instruction
18768 @end smallexample
18769
18770 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
18771 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
18772 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
18773 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
18774 well.
18775
18776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18777
18778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
18779
18780 @subsubheading Example
18781
18782 @smallexample
18783 (gdb)
18784 -exec-step-instruction
18785 ^running
18786
18787 (gdb)
18788 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18789 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18790 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
18791 (gdb)
18792 -exec-step-instruction
18793 ^running
18794
18795 (gdb)
18796 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18797 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18798 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
18799 (gdb)
18800 @end smallexample
18801
18802
18803 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
18804 @findex -exec-until
18805
18806 @subsubheading Synopsis
18807
18808 @smallexample
18809 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
18810 @end smallexample
18811
18812 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
18813 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
18814 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
18815 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
18816
18817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18818
18819 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
18820
18821 @subsubheading Example
18822
18823 @smallexample
18824 (gdb)
18825 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
18826 ^running
18827 (gdb)
18828 x = 55
18829 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18830 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
18831 (gdb)
18832 @end smallexample
18833
18834 @ignore
18835 @subheading -file-clear
18836 Is this going away????
18837 @end ignore
18838
18839 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18840 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
18841 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
18842
18843
18844 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
18845 @findex -stack-info-frame
18846
18847 @subsubheading Synopsis
18848
18849 @smallexample
18850 -stack-info-frame
18851 @end smallexample
18852
18853 Get info on the selected frame.
18854
18855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18856
18857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
18858 (without arguments).
18859
18860 @subsubheading Example
18861
18862 @smallexample
18863 (gdb)
18864 -stack-info-frame
18865 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
18866 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18867 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
18868 (gdb)
18869 @end smallexample
18870
18871 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
18872 @findex -stack-info-depth
18873
18874 @subsubheading Synopsis
18875
18876 @smallexample
18877 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
18878 @end smallexample
18879
18880 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
18881 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
18882
18883 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18884
18885 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
18886
18887 @subsubheading Example
18888
18889 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
18890
18891 @smallexample
18892 (gdb)
18893 -stack-info-depth
18894 ^done,depth="12"
18895 (gdb)
18896 -stack-info-depth 4
18897 ^done,depth="4"
18898 (gdb)
18899 -stack-info-depth 12
18900 ^done,depth="12"
18901 (gdb)
18902 -stack-info-depth 11
18903 ^done,depth="11"
18904 (gdb)
18905 -stack-info-depth 13
18906 ^done,depth="12"
18907 (gdb)
18908 @end smallexample
18909
18910 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
18911 @findex -stack-list-arguments
18912
18913 @subsubheading Synopsis
18914
18915 @smallexample
18916 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
18917 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
18918 @end smallexample
18919
18920 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
18921 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
18922 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
18923 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
18924 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
18925 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
18926 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
18927 which case only existing frames will be returned.
18928
18929 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
18930 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
18931 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
18932
18933 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18934
18935 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
18936 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
18937 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
18938
18939 @subsubheading Example
18940
18941 @smallexample
18942 (gdb)
18943 -stack-list-frames
18944 ^done,
18945 stack=[
18946 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18947 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18948 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
18949 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
18950 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18951 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
18952 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
18953 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18954 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
18955 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
18956 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18957 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
18958 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
18959 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18960 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
18961 (gdb)
18962 -stack-list-arguments 0
18963 ^done,
18964 stack-args=[
18965 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
18966 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
18967 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
18968 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
18969 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
18970 (gdb)
18971 -stack-list-arguments 1
18972 ^done,
18973 stack-args=[
18974 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
18975 frame=@{level="1",
18976 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
18977 frame=@{level="2",args=[
18978 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
18979 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
18980 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
18981 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
18982 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
18983 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
18984 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
18985 (gdb)
18986 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
18987 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
18988 (gdb)
18989 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
18990 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
18991 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
18992 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
18993 (gdb)
18994 @end smallexample
18995
18996 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
18997
18998
18999 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19000 @findex -stack-list-frames
19001
19002 @subsubheading Synopsis
19003
19004 @smallexample
19005 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19006 @end smallexample
19007
19008 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19009 following info:
19010
19011 @table @samp
19012 @item @var{level}
19013 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19014 @item @var{addr}
19015 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19016 @item @var{func}
19017 Function name.
19018 @item @var{file}
19019 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19020 @item @var{line}
19021 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19022 @end table
19023
19024 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19025 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19026 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19027 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19028 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19029 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19030 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19031
19032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19033
19034 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19035
19036 @subsubheading Example
19037
19038 Full stack backtrace:
19039
19040 @smallexample
19041 (gdb)
19042 -stack-list-frames
19043 ^done,stack=
19044 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19045 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19046 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19047 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19048 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19049 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19050 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19051 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19052 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19053 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19054 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19055 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19056 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19057 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19058 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19059 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19060 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19061 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19062 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19063 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19064 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19065 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19066 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19067 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19068 (gdb)
19069 @end smallexample
19070
19071 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19072
19073 @smallexample
19074 (gdb)
19075 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19076 ^done,stack=
19077 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19078 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19079 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19080 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19081 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19082 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19083 (gdb)
19084 @end smallexample
19085
19086 Show a single frame:
19087
19088 @smallexample
19089 (gdb)
19090 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19091 ^done,stack=
19092 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19093 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19094 (gdb)
19095 @end smallexample
19096
19097
19098 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19099 @findex -stack-list-locals
19100
19101 @subsubheading Synopsis
19102
19103 @smallexample
19104 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19105 @end smallexample
19106
19107 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19108 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19109 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19110 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19111 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19112 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19113 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19114 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19115 more detail.
19116
19117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19118
19119 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19120
19121 @subsubheading Example
19122
19123 @smallexample
19124 (gdb)
19125 -stack-list-locals 0
19126 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19127 (gdb)
19128 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19129 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19130 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19131 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19132 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19133 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19134 (gdb)
19135 @end smallexample
19136
19137
19138 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19139 @findex -stack-select-frame
19140
19141 @subsubheading Synopsis
19142
19143 @smallexample
19144 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19145 @end smallexample
19146
19147 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19148 the stack.
19149
19150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19151
19152 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19153 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19154
19155 @subsubheading Example
19156
19157 @smallexample
19158 (gdb)
19159 -stack-select-frame 2
19160 ^done
19161 (gdb)
19162 @end smallexample
19163
19164 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19165 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19166 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19167
19168 @ignore
19169
19170 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19171
19172 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19173 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19174 used by @code{Insight}.
19175
19176 The two main reasons for that are:
19177
19178 @enumerate 1
19179 @item
19180 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19181
19182 @item
19183 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19184 now).
19185 @end enumerate
19186
19187 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19188 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19189 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19190 hints about their use.
19191
19192 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19193 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19194 least, the following operations:
19195
19196 @itemize @bullet
19197 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19198 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19199 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19200 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19201 @end itemize
19202
19203 @end ignore
19204
19205 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19206
19207 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19208
19209 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19210 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19211 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19212 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19213 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19214 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19215 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19216 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19217 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19218 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19219 object, or to change display format.
19220
19221 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19222 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19223 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19224 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19225 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19226 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19227 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19228 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19229 child will be created.
19230
19231 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19232 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19233 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19234 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19235 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19236
19237 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19238 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19239 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19240 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19241 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19242 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19243 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19244 variables that frontend has created.
19245
19246 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19247 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19248 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19249 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19250 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19251 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19252 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19253 implicitly updated.
19254
19255 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19256 access this functionality:
19257
19258 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19259 @item @strong{Operation}
19260 @tab @strong{Description}
19261
19262 @item @code{-var-create}
19263 @tab create a variable object
19264 @item @code{-var-delete}
19265 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19266 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19267 @tab set the display format of this variable
19268 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19269 @tab show the display format of this variable
19270 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19271 @tab tells how many children this object has
19272 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19273 @tab return a list of the object's children
19274 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19275 @tab show the type of this variable object
19276 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19277 @tab print what this variable object represents
19278 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19279 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19280 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19281 @tab get the value of this variable
19282 @item @code{-var-assign}
19283 @tab set the value of this variable
19284 @item @code{-var-update}
19285 @tab update the variable and its children
19286 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19287 @tab set frozeness attribute
19288 @end multitable
19289
19290 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19291 how it can be used.
19292
19293 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19294
19295 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19296 @findex -var-create
19297
19298 @subsubheading Synopsis
19299
19300 @smallexample
19301 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19302 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19303 @end smallexample
19304
19305 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19306 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19307 register.
19308
19309 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19310 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19311 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19312 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19313 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19314
19315 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19316 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19317 frame should be used.
19318
19319 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19320 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19321
19322 @itemize @bullet
19323 @item
19324 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19325
19326 @item
19327 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19328
19329 @item
19330 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19331 @end itemize
19332
19333 @subsubheading Result
19334
19335 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19336 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19337 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19338
19339 @smallexample
19340 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19341 @end smallexample
19342
19343
19344 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19345 @findex -var-delete
19346
19347 @subsubheading Synopsis
19348
19349 @smallexample
19350 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19351 @end smallexample
19352
19353 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19354 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19355
19356 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19357
19358
19359 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19360 @findex -var-set-format
19361
19362 @subsubheading Synopsis
19363
19364 @smallexample
19365 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19366 @end smallexample
19367
19368 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19369 @var{format-spec}.
19370
19371 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19372
19373 @smallexample
19374 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19375 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19376 @end smallexample
19377
19378 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19379 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19380 for pointers, etc.).
19381
19382 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19383 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19384
19385 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19386 @findex -var-show-format
19387
19388 @subsubheading Synopsis
19389
19390 @smallexample
19391 -var-show-format @var{name}
19392 @end smallexample
19393
19394 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19395
19396 @smallexample
19397 @var{format} @expansion{}
19398 @var{format-spec}
19399 @end smallexample
19400
19401
19402 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19403 @findex -var-info-num-children
19404
19405 @subsubheading Synopsis
19406
19407 @smallexample
19408 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19409 @end smallexample
19410
19411 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19412
19413 @smallexample
19414 numchild=@var{n}
19415 @end smallexample
19416
19417
19418 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19419 @findex -var-list-children
19420
19421 @subsubheading Synopsis
19422
19423 @smallexample
19424 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19425 @end smallexample
19426 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19427
19428 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19429 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19430 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19431 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19432 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19433 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19434 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19435 and unions.
19436
19437 @subsubheading Example
19438
19439 @smallexample
19440 (gdb)
19441 -var-list-children n
19442 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19443 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19444 (gdb)
19445 -var-list-children --all-values n
19446 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19447 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19448 @end smallexample
19449
19450
19451 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19452 @findex -var-info-type
19453
19454 @subsubheading Synopsis
19455
19456 @smallexample
19457 -var-info-type @var{name}
19458 @end smallexample
19459
19460 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19461 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19462 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19463
19464 @smallexample
19465 type=@var{typename}
19466 @end smallexample
19467
19468
19469 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19470 @findex -var-info-expression
19471
19472 @subsubheading Synopsis
19473
19474 @smallexample
19475 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19476 @end smallexample
19477
19478 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19479
19480 @smallexample
19481 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19482 @end smallexample
19483
19484 @noindent
19485 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19486
19487 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19488 @findex -var-show-attributes
19489
19490 @subsubheading Synopsis
19491
19492 @smallexample
19493 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19494 @end smallexample
19495
19496 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19497
19498 @smallexample
19499 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19500 @end smallexample
19501
19502 @noindent
19503 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19504
19505 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19506 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19507
19508 @subsubheading Synopsis
19509
19510 @smallexample
19511 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19512 @end smallexample
19513
19514 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19515 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
19516 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
19517
19518 @smallexample
19519 value=@var{value}
19520 @end smallexample
19521
19522 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19523 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19524
19525 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19526 @findex -var-assign
19527
19528 @subsubheading Synopsis
19529
19530 @smallexample
19531 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19532 @end smallexample
19533
19534 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19535 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19536 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19537 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19538
19539 @subsubheading Example
19540
19541 @smallexample
19542 (gdb)
19543 -var-assign var1 3
19544 ^done,value="3"
19545 (gdb)
19546 -var-update *
19547 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19548 (gdb)
19549 @end smallexample
19550
19551 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19552 @findex -var-update
19553 @anchor{-var-update}
19554
19555 @subsubheading Synopsis
19556
19557 @smallexample
19558 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19559 @end smallexample
19560
19561 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
19562 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
19563 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
19564 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
19565 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
19566 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
19567 object names, all existing variable objects are updated. The option
19568 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
19569 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
19570 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
19571 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
19572 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
19573
19574
19575 @subsubheading Example
19576
19577 @smallexample
19578 (gdb)
19579 -var-assign var1 3
19580 ^done,value="3"
19581 (gdb)
19582 -var-update --all-values var1
19583 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19584 type_changed="false"@}]
19585 (gdb)
19586 @end smallexample
19587
19588 @anchor{-var-update-fields}
19589 The field in_scope may take three values:
19590
19591 @table @code
19592 @item "true"
19593 The variable object's current value is valid.
19594
19595 @item "false"
19596 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
19597 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
19598 scope.
19599
19600 @item "invalid"
19601 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
19602 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
19603 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
19604 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
19605 objects.
19606 @end table
19607
19608 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
19609 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
19610
19611 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
19612 @findex -var-set-frozen
19613
19614 @subsubheading Synopsis
19615
19616 @smallexample
19617 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @samp{flag}
19618 @end smallexample
19619
19620 Set the frozeness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
19621 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
19622 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfozen. If a variable object is
19623 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
19624 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} (@pxref{-var-update}) of
19625 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
19626 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
19627 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
19628 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
19629 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
19630 @code{-var-update} does.
19631
19632 @subsubheading Example
19633
19634 @smallexample
19635 (gdb)
19636 -var-set-frozen V 1
19637 ^done
19638 (gdb)
19639 @end smallexample
19640
19641
19642 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19643 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19644 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19645
19646 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19647 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19648 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19649 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19650
19651 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19652 @c @subheading -data-assign
19653 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19654 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
19655 @c set variable
19656 @c @subsubheading Example
19657 @c N.A.
19658
19659 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19660 @findex -data-disassemble
19661
19662 @subsubheading Synopsis
19663
19664 @smallexample
19665 -data-disassemble
19666 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19667 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19668 -- @var{mode}
19669 @end smallexample
19670
19671 @noindent
19672 Where:
19673
19674 @table @samp
19675 @item @var{start-addr}
19676 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19677 @item @var{end-addr}
19678 is the end address
19679 @item @var{filename}
19680 is the name of the file to disassemble
19681 @item @var{linenum}
19682 is the line number to disassemble around
19683 @item @var{lines}
19684 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19685 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19686 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19687 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19688 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19689 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19690 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19691 are displayed.
19692 @item @var{mode}
19693 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19694 disassembly).
19695 @end table
19696
19697 @subsubheading Result
19698
19699 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19700
19701 @itemize @bullet
19702 @item Address
19703 @item Func-name
19704 @item Offset
19705 @item Instruction
19706 @end itemize
19707
19708 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19709 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
19710
19711 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19712
19713 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19714
19715 @subsubheading Example
19716
19717 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19718
19719 @smallexample
19720 (gdb)
19721 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19722 ^done,
19723 asm_insns=[
19724 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19725 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19726 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19727 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19728 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19729 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19730 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19731 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19732 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19733 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19734 (gdb)
19735 @end smallexample
19736
19737 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19738 @code{main}.
19739
19740 @smallexample
19741 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19742 ^done,asm_insns=[
19743 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19744 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19745 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19746 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19747 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19748 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19749 [@dots{}]
19750 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
19751 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
19752 (gdb)
19753 @end smallexample
19754
19755 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
19756
19757 @smallexample
19758 (gdb)
19759 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
19760 ^done,asm_insns=[
19761 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19762 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19763 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19764 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19765 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19766 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
19767 (gdb)
19768 @end smallexample
19769
19770 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
19771
19772 @smallexample
19773 (gdb)
19774 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
19775 ^done,asm_insns=[
19776 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
19777 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19778 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19779 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19780 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
19781 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
19782 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19783 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19784 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19785 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19786 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19787 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
19788 (gdb)
19789 @end smallexample
19790
19791
19792 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
19793 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
19794
19795 @subsubheading Synopsis
19796
19797 @smallexample
19798 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
19799 @end smallexample
19800
19801 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
19802 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
19803 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
19804
19805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19806
19807 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
19808 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
19809 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
19810
19811 @subsubheading Example
19812
19813 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
19814 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
19815 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
19816 output.
19817
19818 @smallexample
19819 211-data-evaluate-expression A
19820 211^done,value="1"
19821 (gdb)
19822 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
19823 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
19824 (gdb)
19825 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
19826 411^done,value="4"
19827 (gdb)
19828 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
19829 511^done,value="4"
19830 (gdb)
19831 @end smallexample
19832
19833
19834 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
19835 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
19836
19837 @subsubheading Synopsis
19838
19839 @smallexample
19840 -data-list-changed-registers
19841 @end smallexample
19842
19843 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
19844
19845 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19846
19847 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
19848 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
19849
19850 @subsubheading Example
19851
19852 On a PPC MBX board:
19853
19854 @smallexample
19855 (gdb)
19856 -exec-continue
19857 ^running
19858
19859 (gdb)
19860 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
19861 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
19862 (gdb)
19863 -data-list-changed-registers
19864 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
19865 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
19866 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
19867 (gdb)
19868 @end smallexample
19869
19870
19871 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
19872 @findex -data-list-register-names
19873
19874 @subsubheading Synopsis
19875
19876 @smallexample
19877 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
19878 @end smallexample
19879
19880 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
19881 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
19882 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
19883 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
19884 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
19885 include empty register names.
19886
19887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19888
19889 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
19890 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
19891 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
19892
19893 @subsubheading Example
19894
19895 For the PPC MBX board:
19896 @smallexample
19897 (gdb)
19898 -data-list-register-names
19899 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
19900 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
19901 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
19902 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
19903 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
19904 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
19905 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
19906 (gdb)
19907 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
19908 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
19909 (gdb)
19910 @end smallexample
19911
19912 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
19913 @findex -data-list-register-values
19914
19915 @subsubheading Synopsis
19916
19917 @smallexample
19918 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
19919 @end smallexample
19920
19921 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
19922 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
19923 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
19924 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
19925
19926 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
19927
19928 @table @code
19929 @item x
19930 Hexadecimal
19931 @item o
19932 Octal
19933 @item t
19934 Binary
19935 @item d
19936 Decimal
19937 @item r
19938 Raw
19939 @item N
19940 Natural
19941 @end table
19942
19943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19944
19945 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
19946 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
19947
19948 @subsubheading Example
19949
19950 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
19951 don't appear in the actual output):
19952
19953 @smallexample
19954 (gdb)
19955 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
19956 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
19957 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
19958 (gdb)
19959 -data-list-register-values x
19960 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
19961 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
19962 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
19963 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
19964 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
19965 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
19966 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
19967 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
19968 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
19969 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
19970 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
19971 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
19972 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
19973 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
19974 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
19975 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
19976 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
19977 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
19978 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
19979 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
19980 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
19981 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
19982 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
19983 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
19984 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
19985 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
19986 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
19987 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
19988 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
19989 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
19990 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
19991 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
19992 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
19993 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
19994 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
19995 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
19996 (gdb)
19997 @end smallexample
19998
19999
20000 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20001 @findex -data-read-memory
20002
20003 @subsubheading Synopsis
20004
20005 @smallexample
20006 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20007 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20008 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20009 @end smallexample
20010
20011 @noindent
20012 where:
20013
20014 @table @samp
20015 @item @var{address}
20016 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20017 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20018 quoted using the C convention.
20019
20020 @item @var{word-format}
20021 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20022 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20023 ,Output Formats}).
20024
20025 @item @var{word-size}
20026 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20027
20028 @item @var{nr-rows}
20029 The number of rows in the output table.
20030
20031 @item @var{nr-cols}
20032 The number of columns in the output table.
20033
20034 @item @var{aschar}
20035 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20036 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20037 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20038 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20039
20040 @item @var{byte-offset}
20041 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20042 @end table
20043
20044 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20045 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20046 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20047 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20048 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20049 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20050 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20051 @samp{addr}.
20052
20053 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20054 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20055 @samp{prev-page}.
20056
20057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20058
20059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20060 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20061
20062 @subsubheading Example
20063
20064 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20065 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20066 word. Display each word in hex.
20067
20068 @smallexample
20069 (gdb)
20070 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20071 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20072 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20073 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20074 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20075 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20076 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20077 (gdb)
20078 @end smallexample
20079
20080 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20081 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20082
20083 @smallexample
20084 (gdb)
20085 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20086 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20087 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20088 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20089 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20090 (gdb)
20091 @end smallexample
20092
20093 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20094 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20095 used as the non-printable character.
20096
20097 @smallexample
20098 (gdb)
20099 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20100 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20101 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20102 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20103 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20104 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20105 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20106 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20107 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20108 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20109 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20110 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20111 (gdb)
20112 @end smallexample
20113
20114 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20115 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20116 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20117
20118 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20119
20120 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20121
20122 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20123
20124 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20125
20126 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20127
20128 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20129
20130 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20131
20132 @c @subheading -trace-find
20133
20134 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20135
20136 @c @subheading -trace-info
20137
20138 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20139
20140 @c @subheading -trace-list
20141
20142 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20143
20144 @c @subheading -trace-save
20145
20146 @c @subheading -trace-start
20147
20148 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20149
20150
20151 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20152 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20153 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20154
20155
20156 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20157 @findex -symbol-info-address
20158
20159 @subsubheading Synopsis
20160
20161 @smallexample
20162 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20163 @end smallexample
20164
20165 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20166
20167 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20168
20169 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20170
20171 @subsubheading Example
20172 N.A.
20173
20174
20175 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20176 @findex -symbol-info-file
20177
20178 @subsubheading Synopsis
20179
20180 @smallexample
20181 -symbol-info-file
20182 @end smallexample
20183
20184 Show the file for the symbol.
20185
20186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20187
20188 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20189 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20190
20191 @subsubheading Example
20192 N.A.
20193
20194
20195 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20196 @findex -symbol-info-function
20197
20198 @subsubheading Synopsis
20199
20200 @smallexample
20201 -symbol-info-function
20202 @end smallexample
20203
20204 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20205
20206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20207
20208 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20209
20210 @subsubheading Example
20211 N.A.
20212
20213
20214 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20215 @findex -symbol-info-line
20216
20217 @subsubheading Synopsis
20218
20219 @smallexample
20220 -symbol-info-line
20221 @end smallexample
20222
20223 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20224
20225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20226
20227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20228 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20229
20230 @subsubheading Example
20231 N.A.
20232
20233
20234 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20235 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20236
20237 @subsubheading Synopsis
20238
20239 @smallexample
20240 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20241 @end smallexample
20242
20243 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20244
20245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20246
20247 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20248
20249 @subsubheading Example
20250 N.A.
20251
20252
20253 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20254 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20255
20256 @subsubheading Synopsis
20257
20258 @smallexample
20259 -symbol-list-functions
20260 @end smallexample
20261
20262 List the functions in the executable.
20263
20264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20265
20266 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20267 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20268
20269 @subsubheading Example
20270 N.A.
20271
20272
20273 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20274 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20275
20276 @subsubheading Synopsis
20277
20278 @smallexample
20279 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20280 @end smallexample
20281
20282 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20283 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20284 ascending PC order.
20285
20286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20287
20288 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20289
20290 @subsubheading Example
20291 @smallexample
20292 (gdb)
20293 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20294 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20295 (gdb)
20296 @end smallexample
20297
20298
20299 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20300 @findex -symbol-list-types
20301
20302 @subsubheading Synopsis
20303
20304 @smallexample
20305 -symbol-list-types
20306 @end smallexample
20307
20308 List all the type names.
20309
20310 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20311
20312 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20313 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20314
20315 @subsubheading Example
20316 N.A.
20317
20318
20319 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20320 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20321
20322 @subsubheading Synopsis
20323
20324 @smallexample
20325 -symbol-list-variables
20326 @end smallexample
20327
20328 List all the global and static variable names.
20329
20330 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20331
20332 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20333
20334 @subsubheading Example
20335 N.A.
20336
20337
20338 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20339 @findex -symbol-locate
20340
20341 @subsubheading Synopsis
20342
20343 @smallexample
20344 -symbol-locate
20345 @end smallexample
20346
20347 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20348
20349 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20350
20351 @subsubheading Example
20352 N.A.
20353
20354
20355 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20356 @findex -symbol-type
20357
20358 @subsubheading Synopsis
20359
20360 @smallexample
20361 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20362 @end smallexample
20363
20364 Show type of @var{variable}.
20365
20366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20367
20368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20369 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20370
20371 @subsubheading Example
20372 N.A.
20373
20374
20375 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20376 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20377 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20378
20379 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20380 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20381
20382 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20383 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20384
20385 @subsubheading Synopsis
20386
20387 @smallexample
20388 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20389 @end smallexample
20390
20391 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20392 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20393 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20394 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20395 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20396 notification.
20397
20398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20399
20400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20401
20402 @subsubheading Example
20403
20404 @smallexample
20405 (gdb)
20406 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20407 ^done
20408 (gdb)
20409 @end smallexample
20410
20411
20412 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20413 @findex -file-exec-file
20414
20415 @subsubheading Synopsis
20416
20417 @smallexample
20418 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20419 @end smallexample
20420
20421 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20422 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20423 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20424 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20425 notification.
20426
20427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20428
20429 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20430
20431 @subsubheading Example
20432
20433 @smallexample
20434 (gdb)
20435 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20436 ^done
20437 (gdb)
20438 @end smallexample
20439
20440
20441 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20442 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20443
20444 @subsubheading Synopsis
20445
20446 @smallexample
20447 -file-list-exec-sections
20448 @end smallexample
20449
20450 List the sections of the current executable file.
20451
20452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20453
20454 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20455 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20456 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20457
20458 @subsubheading Example
20459 N.A.
20460
20461
20462 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20463 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20464
20465 @subsubheading Synopsis
20466
20467 @smallexample
20468 -file-list-exec-source-file
20469 @end smallexample
20470
20471 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20472 to the current source file for the current executable.
20473
20474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20475
20476 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20477
20478 @subsubheading Example
20479
20480 @smallexample
20481 (gdb)
20482 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20483 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20484 (gdb)
20485 @end smallexample
20486
20487
20488 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20489 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20490
20491 @subsubheading Synopsis
20492
20493 @smallexample
20494 -file-list-exec-source-files
20495 @end smallexample
20496
20497 List the source files for the current executable.
20498
20499 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
20500 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20501
20502 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20503
20504 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20505 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20506
20507 @subsubheading Example
20508 @smallexample
20509 (gdb)
20510 -file-list-exec-source-files
20511 ^done,files=[
20512 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20513 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20514 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20515 (gdb)
20516 @end smallexample
20517
20518 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20519 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20520
20521 @subsubheading Synopsis
20522
20523 @smallexample
20524 -file-list-shared-libraries
20525 @end smallexample
20526
20527 List the shared libraries in the program.
20528
20529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20530
20531 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20532
20533 @subsubheading Example
20534 N.A.
20535
20536
20537 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20538 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20539
20540 @subsubheading Synopsis
20541
20542 @smallexample
20543 -file-list-symbol-files
20544 @end smallexample
20545
20546 List symbol files.
20547
20548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20549
20550 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20551
20552 @subsubheading Example
20553 N.A.
20554
20555
20556 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20557 @findex -file-symbol-file
20558
20559 @subsubheading Synopsis
20560
20561 @smallexample
20562 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20563 @end smallexample
20564
20565 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20566 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20567 produced, except for a completion notification.
20568
20569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20570
20571 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20572
20573 @subsubheading Example
20574
20575 @smallexample
20576 (gdb)
20577 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20578 ^done
20579 (gdb)
20580 @end smallexample
20581
20582 @ignore
20583 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20584 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20585 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20586
20587 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20588
20589 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20590
20591 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20592
20593 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20594
20595 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20596
20597 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20598
20599 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20600
20601 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20602
20603 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20604 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20605 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20606
20607 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20608
20609 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20610
20611 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20612
20613 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20614 @end ignore
20615
20616
20617 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20618 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20619 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20620
20621
20622 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20623 @findex -target-attach
20624
20625 @subsubheading Synopsis
20626
20627 @smallexample
20628 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20629 @end smallexample
20630
20631 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20632
20633 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20634
20635 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20636
20637 @subsubheading Example
20638 N.A.
20639
20640
20641 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20642 @findex -target-compare-sections
20643
20644 @subsubheading Synopsis
20645
20646 @smallexample
20647 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20648 @end smallexample
20649
20650 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20651 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20652
20653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20654
20655 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20656
20657 @subsubheading Example
20658 N.A.
20659
20660
20661 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20662 @findex -target-detach
20663
20664 @subsubheading Synopsis
20665
20666 @smallexample
20667 -target-detach
20668 @end smallexample
20669
20670 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20671 There's no output.
20672
20673 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20674
20675 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20676
20677 @subsubheading Example
20678
20679 @smallexample
20680 (gdb)
20681 -target-detach
20682 ^done
20683 (gdb)
20684 @end smallexample
20685
20686
20687 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20688 @findex -target-disconnect
20689
20690 @subsubheading Synopsis
20691
20692 @smallexample
20693 -target-disconnect
20694 @end smallexample
20695
20696 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20697 generally not resumed.
20698
20699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20700
20701 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20702
20703 @subsubheading Example
20704
20705 @smallexample
20706 (gdb)
20707 -target-disconnect
20708 ^done
20709 (gdb)
20710 @end smallexample
20711
20712
20713 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20714 @findex -target-download
20715
20716 @subsubheading Synopsis
20717
20718 @smallexample
20719 -target-download
20720 @end smallexample
20721
20722 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20723 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20724
20725 @table @samp
20726 @item section
20727 The name of the section.
20728 @item section-sent
20729 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20730 @item section-size
20731 The size of the section.
20732 @item total-sent
20733 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20734 @item total-size
20735 The size of the overall executable to download.
20736 @end table
20737
20738 @noindent
20739 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20740 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20741
20742 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20743 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20744
20745 @table @samp
20746 @item section
20747 The name of the section.
20748 @item section-size
20749 The size of the section.
20750 @item total-size
20751 The size of the overall executable to download.
20752 @end table
20753
20754 @noindent
20755 At the end, a summary is printed.
20756
20757 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20758
20759 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20760
20761 @subsubheading Example
20762
20763 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20764 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20765
20766 @smallexample
20767 (gdb)
20768 -target-download
20769 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20770 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20771 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20772 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20773 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20774 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20775 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20776 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20777 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20778 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20779 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20780 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20781 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
20782 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
20783 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
20784 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
20785 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
20786 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
20787 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
20788 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
20789 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
20790 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
20791 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
20792 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
20793 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
20794 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
20795 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
20796 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20797 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20798 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
20799 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
20800 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
20801 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
20802 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
20803 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
20804 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
20805 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
20806 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
20807 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
20808 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
20809 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
20810 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
20811 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
20812 write-rate="429"
20813 (gdb)
20814 @end smallexample
20815
20816
20817 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
20818 @findex -target-exec-status
20819
20820 @subsubheading Synopsis
20821
20822 @smallexample
20823 -target-exec-status
20824 @end smallexample
20825
20826 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
20827 not, for instance).
20828
20829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20830
20831 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20832
20833 @subsubheading Example
20834 N.A.
20835
20836
20837 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
20838 @findex -target-list-available-targets
20839
20840 @subsubheading Synopsis
20841
20842 @smallexample
20843 -target-list-available-targets
20844 @end smallexample
20845
20846 List the possible targets to connect to.
20847
20848 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20849
20850 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
20851
20852 @subsubheading Example
20853 N.A.
20854
20855
20856 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
20857 @findex -target-list-current-targets
20858
20859 @subsubheading Synopsis
20860
20861 @smallexample
20862 -target-list-current-targets
20863 @end smallexample
20864
20865 Describe the current target.
20866
20867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20868
20869 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
20870 other things).
20871
20872 @subsubheading Example
20873 N.A.
20874
20875
20876 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
20877 @findex -target-list-parameters
20878
20879 @subsubheading Synopsis
20880
20881 @smallexample
20882 -target-list-parameters
20883 @end smallexample
20884
20885 @c ????
20886
20887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20888
20889 No equivalent.
20890
20891 @subsubheading Example
20892 N.A.
20893
20894
20895 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
20896 @findex -target-select
20897
20898 @subsubheading Synopsis
20899
20900 @smallexample
20901 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
20902 @end smallexample
20903
20904 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
20905
20906 @table @samp
20907 @item @var{type}
20908 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
20909 @item @var{parameters}
20910 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
20911 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
20912 @end table
20913
20914 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
20915 which the target program is, in the following form:
20916
20917 @smallexample
20918 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
20919 args=[@var{arg list}]
20920 @end smallexample
20921
20922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20923
20924 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
20925
20926 @subsubheading Example
20927
20928 @smallexample
20929 (gdb)
20930 -target-select async /dev/ttya
20931 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
20932 (gdb)
20933 @end smallexample
20934
20935 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20936 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
20937 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
20938
20939 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
20940
20941 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
20942 @findex -gdb-exit
20943
20944 @subsubheading Synopsis
20945
20946 @smallexample
20947 -gdb-exit
20948 @end smallexample
20949
20950 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
20951
20952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20953
20954 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
20955
20956 @subsubheading Example
20957
20958 @smallexample
20959 (gdb)
20960 -gdb-exit
20961 ^exit
20962 @end smallexample
20963
20964
20965 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
20966 @findex -exec-abort
20967
20968 @subsubheading Synopsis
20969
20970 @smallexample
20971 -exec-abort
20972 @end smallexample
20973
20974 Kill the inferior running program.
20975
20976 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20977
20978 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
20979
20980 @subsubheading Example
20981 N.A.
20982
20983
20984 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
20985 @findex -gdb-set
20986
20987 @subsubheading Synopsis
20988
20989 @smallexample
20990 -gdb-set
20991 @end smallexample
20992
20993 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
20994 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
20995
20996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20997
20998 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
20999
21000 @subsubheading Example
21001
21002 @smallexample
21003 (gdb)
21004 -gdb-set $foo=3
21005 ^done
21006 (gdb)
21007 @end smallexample
21008
21009
21010 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21011 @findex -gdb-show
21012
21013 @subsubheading Synopsis
21014
21015 @smallexample
21016 -gdb-show
21017 @end smallexample
21018
21019 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21020
21021 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21022
21023 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21024
21025 @subsubheading Example
21026
21027 @smallexample
21028 (gdb)
21029 -gdb-show annotate
21030 ^done,value="0"
21031 (gdb)
21032 @end smallexample
21033
21034 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21035
21036
21037 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21038 @findex -gdb-version
21039
21040 @subsubheading Synopsis
21041
21042 @smallexample
21043 -gdb-version
21044 @end smallexample
21045
21046 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21047
21048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21049
21050 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21051 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21052
21053 @subsubheading Example
21054
21055 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21056 @c box in TeX.
21057 @smallexample
21058 (gdb)
21059 -gdb-version
21060 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21061 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21062 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21063 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21064 ~ certain conditions.
21065 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21066 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21067 ~ details.
21068 ~This GDB was configured as
21069 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21070 ^done
21071 (gdb)
21072 @end smallexample
21073
21074 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21075 @findex -interpreter-exec
21076
21077 @subheading Synopsis
21078
21079 @smallexample
21080 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21081 @end smallexample
21082 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21083
21084 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21085
21086 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21087
21088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21089
21090 @subheading Example
21091
21092 @smallexample
21093 (gdb)
21094 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21095 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21096 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21097 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21098 ^done
21099 (gdb)
21100 @end smallexample
21101
21102 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21103 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21104
21105 @subheading Synopsis
21106
21107 @smallexample
21108 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21109 @end smallexample
21110
21111 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21112
21113 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21114
21115 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21116
21117 @subheading Example
21118
21119 @smallexample
21120 (gdb)
21121 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21122 ^done
21123 (gdb)
21124 @end smallexample
21125
21126 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21127 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21128
21129 @subheading Synopsis
21130
21131 @smallexample
21132 -inferior-tty-show
21133 @end smallexample
21134
21135 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21136
21137 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21138
21139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21140
21141 @subheading Example
21142
21143 @smallexample
21144 (gdb)
21145 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21146 ^done
21147 (gdb)
21148 -inferior-tty-show
21149 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21150 (gdb)
21151 @end smallexample
21152
21153 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21154 @findex -enable-timings
21155
21156 @subheading Synopsis
21157
21158 @smallexample
21159 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21160 @end smallexample
21161
21162 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21163 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21164 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21165 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21166
21167 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21168
21169 No equivalent.
21170
21171 @subheading Example
21172
21173 @smallexample
21174 (gdb)
21175 -enable-timings
21176 ^done
21177 (gdb)
21178 -break-insert main
21179 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21180 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21181 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21182 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21183 (gdb)
21184 -enable-timings no
21185 ^done
21186 (gdb)
21187 -exec-run
21188 ^running
21189 (gdb)
21190 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21191 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21192 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21193 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21194 (gdb)
21195 @end smallexample
21196
21197 @node Annotations
21198 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21199
21200 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21201 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21202 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21203 relatively high level.
21204
21205 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21206 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21207
21208 @ignore
21209 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21210 @end ignore
21211
21212 @menu
21213 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21214 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21215 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21216 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21217 * Annotations for Running::
21218 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21219 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21220 @end menu
21221
21222 @node Annotations Overview
21223 @section What is an Annotation?
21224 @cindex annotations
21225
21226 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21227 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21228 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21229 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21230 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21231 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21232 cannot contain newline characters.
21233
21234 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21235 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21236 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21237 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21238 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21239 means those three characters as output.
21240
21241 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21242 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21243 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21244 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21245 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21246 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21247 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21248 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21249 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21250
21251 @table @code
21252 @kindex set annotate
21253 @item set annotate @var{level}
21254 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21255 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21256
21257 @item show annotate
21258 @kindex show annotate
21259 Show the current annotation level.
21260 @end table
21261
21262 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21263
21264 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21265
21266 @smallexample
21267 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21268 GNU gdb 6.0
21269 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21270 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21271 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21272 under certain conditions.
21273 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21274 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21275 for details.
21276 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21277
21278 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21279 (@value{GDBP})
21280 ^Z^Zprompt
21281 @kbd{quit}
21282
21283 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21284 $
21285 @end smallexample
21286
21287 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21288 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21289 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21290 output from @value{GDBN}.
21291
21292 @node Prompting
21293 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21294
21295 @cindex annotations for prompts
21296 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21297 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21298 over, etc.
21299
21300 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21301 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21302 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21303 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21304 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21305 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21306 features the following annotations:
21307
21308 @smallexample
21309 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21310 ^Z^Zprompt
21311 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21312 @end smallexample
21313
21314 The input types are
21315
21316 @table @code
21317 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21318 @findex prompt annotation
21319 @findex post-prompt annotation
21320 @item prompt
21321 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21322
21323 @findex pre-commands annotation
21324 @findex commands annotation
21325 @findex post-commands annotation
21326 @item commands
21327 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21328 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21329
21330 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21331 @findex overload-choice annotation
21332 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21333 @item overload-choice
21334 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21335
21336 @findex pre-query annotation
21337 @findex query annotation
21338 @findex post-query annotation
21339 @item query
21340 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21341
21342 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21343 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21344 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21345 @item prompt-for-continue
21346 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21347 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21348 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21349 presence of annotations.
21350 @end table
21351
21352 @node Errors
21353 @section Errors
21354 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21355
21356 @findex quit annotation
21357 @smallexample
21358 ^Z^Zquit
21359 @end smallexample
21360
21361 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21362
21363 @findex error annotation
21364 @smallexample
21365 ^Z^Zerror
21366 @end smallexample
21367
21368 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21369
21370 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21371 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21372 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21373 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21374 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21375 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21376 to the top level.
21377
21378 @findex error-begin annotation
21379 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21380
21381 @smallexample
21382 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21383 @end smallexample
21384
21385 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21386 message.
21387
21388 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21389 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21390 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21391
21392 @node Invalidation
21393 @section Invalidation Notices
21394
21395 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21396 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21397 changed.
21398
21399 @table @code
21400 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21401 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21402
21403 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21404 have changed.
21405
21406 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21407 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21408
21409 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21410 deleted a breakpoint.
21411 @end table
21412
21413 @node Annotations for Running
21414 @section Running the Program
21415 @cindex annotations for running programs
21416
21417 @findex starting annotation
21418 @findex stopping annotation
21419 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21420 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21421
21422 @smallexample
21423 ^Z^Zstarting
21424 @end smallexample
21425
21426 is output. When the program stops,
21427
21428 @smallexample
21429 ^Z^Zstopped
21430 @end smallexample
21431
21432 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21433 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21434
21435 @table @code
21436 @findex exited annotation
21437 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21438 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21439 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21440
21441 @findex signalled annotation
21442 @findex signal-name annotation
21443 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21444 @findex signal-string annotation
21445 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21446 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21447 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21448 annotation continues:
21449
21450 @smallexample
21451 @var{intro-text}
21452 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21453 @var{name}
21454 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21455 @var{middle-text}
21456 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21457 @var{string}
21458 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21459 @var{end-text}
21460 @end smallexample
21461
21462 @noindent
21463 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21464 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21465 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21466 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21467 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21468
21469 @findex signal annotation
21470 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21471 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21472 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21473 terminated with it.
21474
21475 @findex breakpoint annotation
21476 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21477 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21478
21479 @findex watchpoint annotation
21480 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21481 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21482 @end table
21483
21484 @node Source Annotations
21485 @section Displaying Source
21486 @cindex annotations for source display
21487
21488 @findex source annotation
21489 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21490
21491 @smallexample
21492 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21493 @end smallexample
21494
21495 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21496 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21497 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21498 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21499 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21500 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21501 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21502 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21503 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21504 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21505 depend on the language).
21506
21507 @node GDB Bugs
21508 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21509 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21510 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21511
21512 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21513
21514 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21515 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21516 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21517 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21518
21519 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21520 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21521
21522 @menu
21523 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21524 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21525 @end menu
21526
21527 @node Bug Criteria
21528 @section Have You Found a Bug?
21529 @cindex bug criteria
21530
21531 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21532
21533 @itemize @bullet
21534 @cindex fatal signal
21535 @cindex debugger crash
21536 @cindex crash of debugger
21537 @item
21538 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21539 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21540
21541 @cindex error on valid input
21542 @item
21543 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21544 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21545 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21546
21547 @cindex invalid input
21548 @item
21549 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21550 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21551 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21552 for traditional practice''.
21553
21554 @item
21555 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21556 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21557 @end itemize
21558
21559 @node Bug Reporting
21560 @section How to Report Bugs
21561 @cindex bug reports
21562 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21563
21564 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21565 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21566 contact that organization first.
21567
21568 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21569 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21570 distribution.
21571 @c should add a web page ref...
21572
21573 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21574 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
21575 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21576 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21577 be used.
21578
21579 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21580 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21581 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21582 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21583
21584 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21585 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21586 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21587 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21588 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21589 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21590 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21591 bug reports to the mailing list.
21592
21593 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21594 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21595 fact or leave it out, state it!
21596
21597 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21598 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21599 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21600 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21601 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21602 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21603 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21604 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21605 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21606
21607 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21608 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21609 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21610 self-contained.
21611
21612 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21613 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21614 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21615 bugs properly.
21616
21617 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21618
21619 @itemize @bullet
21620 @item
21621 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21622 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21623 version}.
21624
21625 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21626 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21627
21628 @item
21629 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21630 version number.
21631
21632 @item
21633 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21634 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21635
21636 @item
21637 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21638 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21639 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
21640 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
21641 those compilers.
21642
21643 @item
21644 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21645 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21646 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21647 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21648
21649 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21650 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21651
21652 @item
21653 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21654 reproduce the bug.
21655
21656 @item
21657 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21658 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21659
21660 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21661 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21662 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21663 a chance to make a mistake.
21664
21665 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21666 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21667 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21668 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21669 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21670 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21671 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21672 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21673
21674 @pindex script
21675 @cindex recording a session script
21676 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21677 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21678 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21679 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21680
21681 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21682 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21683
21684 @item
21685 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21686 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21687 it by context, not by line number.
21688
21689 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21690 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21691
21692 @end itemize
21693
21694 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21695
21696 @itemize @bullet
21697 @item
21698 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21699
21700 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21701 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21702 changes will not affect it.
21703
21704 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21705 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21706 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21707 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21708
21709 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21710 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21711 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21712 less time, and so on.
21713
21714 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21715 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21716
21717 @item
21718 A patch for the bug.
21719
21720 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21721 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21722 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21723 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21724
21725 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21726 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21727 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21728 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21729
21730 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21731 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21732 help us to understand.
21733
21734 @item
21735 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21736
21737 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21738 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21739 @end itemize
21740
21741 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21742 @c and consists of the two following files:
21743 @c rluser.texinfo
21744 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21745 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21746 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21747 @include rluser.texi
21748 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21749
21750
21751 @node Formatting Documentation
21752 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21753
21754 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21755 @cindex reference card
21756 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21757 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21758 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21759 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21760 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21761 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21762
21763 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21764 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21765
21766 @smallexample
21767 make refcard.dvi
21768 @end smallexample
21769
21770 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21771 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21772 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21773 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21774 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21775
21776 @cindex documentation
21777
21778 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21779 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21780 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21781 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21782 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21783 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21784
21785 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21786 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21787 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21788 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21789 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21790 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21791 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21792 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21793
21794 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21795 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21796 @code{makeinfo}.
21797
21798 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21799 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21800 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21801
21802 @smallexample
21803 cd gdb
21804 make gdb.info
21805 @end smallexample
21806
21807 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21808 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21809 Texinfo definitions file.
21810
21811 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21812 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21813 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21814 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21815 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21816 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21817 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21818
21819 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21820 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21821 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21822 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21823 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21824 directory.
21825
21826 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
21827 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
21828 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
21829 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
21830
21831 @smallexample
21832 make gdb.dvi
21833 @end smallexample
21834
21835 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
21836
21837 @node Installing GDB
21838 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
21839 @cindex installation
21840
21841 @menu
21842 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
21843 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
21844 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21845 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
21846 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
21847 @end menu
21848
21849 @node Requirements
21850 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
21851 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
21852
21853 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
21854 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
21855
21856 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
21857 @table @asis
21858 @item ISO C90 compiler
21859 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
21860 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
21861
21862 @end table
21863
21864 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
21865 @table @asis
21866 @item Expat
21867 @anchor{Expat}
21868 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
21869 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
21870 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
21871 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
21872 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
21873 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
21874
21875 Expat is used for remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
21876 and for target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions}).
21877
21878 @end table
21879
21880 @node Running Configure
21881 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
21882 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
21883 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
21884 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
21885 build the @code{gdb} program.
21886 @iftex
21887 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
21888 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
21889 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
21890 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
21891 @end iftex
21892
21893 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
21894 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
21895 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
21896
21897 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
21898 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
21899
21900 @table @code
21901 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
21902 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
21903
21904 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
21905 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
21906
21907 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
21908 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
21909
21910 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
21911 @sc{gnu} include files
21912
21913 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
21914 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
21915
21916 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
21917 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
21918
21919 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
21920 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
21921
21922 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
21923 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
21924
21925 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
21926 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
21927 @end table
21928
21929 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
21930 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
21931 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
21932
21933 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
21934 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
21935 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
21936 argument.
21937
21938 For example:
21939
21940 @smallexample
21941 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21942 ./configure @var{host}
21943 make
21944 @end smallexample
21945
21946 @noindent
21947 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
21948 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
21949 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
21950 correct value by examining your system.)
21951
21952 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
21953 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
21954 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
21955 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
21956
21957 @need 750
21958 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
21959 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
21960 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
21961
21962 @smallexample
21963 sh configure @var{host}
21964 @end smallexample
21965
21966 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
21967 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
21968 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
21969 @file{configure}
21970 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
21971 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
21972
21973 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
21974 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
21975 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
21976 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
21977 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
21978 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
21979 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
21980 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
21981 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21982
21983 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
21984 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
21985 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
21986 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
21987 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
21988
21989 @node Separate Objdir
21990 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
21991
21992 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
21993 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
21994 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
21995 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
21996 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
21997 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
21998 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
21999 program specified there.
22000
22001 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22002 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22003 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22004 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22005 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22006 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22007
22008 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22009 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22010
22011 @smallexample
22012 @group
22013 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22014 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22015 cd ../gdb-sun4
22016 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22017 make
22018 @end group
22019 @end smallexample
22020
22021 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22022 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22023 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22024 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22025 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22026 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22027
22028 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22029 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22030 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22031 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22032 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22033
22034 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22035 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22036 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22037 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22038 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22039 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22040
22041 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22042 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22043 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22044
22045 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22046 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22047 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22048 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22049 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22050
22051 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22052 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22053 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22054 with each other.
22055
22056 @node Config Names
22057 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22058
22059 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22060 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22061 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22062 of information in the following pattern:
22063
22064 @smallexample
22065 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22066 @end smallexample
22067
22068 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22069 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22070 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22071
22072 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22073 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22074 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22075 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22076 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22077 abbreviations---for example:
22078
22079 @smallexample
22080 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22081 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22082 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22083 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22084 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22085 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22086 % sh config.sub sun4
22087 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22088 % sh config.sub sun3
22089 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22090 % sh config.sub i986v
22091 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22092 @end smallexample
22093
22094 @noindent
22095 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22096 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22097
22098 @node Configure Options
22099 @section @file{configure} Options
22100
22101 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22102 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22103 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22104 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22105
22106 @smallexample
22107 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22108 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22109 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22110 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22111 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22112 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22113 @var{host}
22114 @end smallexample
22115
22116 @noindent
22117 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22118 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22119 @samp{--}.
22120
22121 @table @code
22122 @item --help
22123 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22124
22125 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22126 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22127 @file{@var{dir}}.
22128
22129 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22130 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22131 @file{@var{dir}}.
22132
22133 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22134 @need 2000
22135 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22136 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22137 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22138 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22139 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22140 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22141 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22142 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22143 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22144 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22145 @var{dirname}.
22146
22147 @item --norecursion
22148 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22149 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22150
22151 @item --target=@var{target}
22152 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22153 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22154 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22155
22156 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22157
22158 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22159 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22160
22161 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22162 @end table
22163
22164 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22165 needed for special purposes only.
22166
22167 @node Maintenance Commands
22168 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22169 @cindex maintenance commands
22170 @cindex internal commands
22171
22172 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22173 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22174 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22175 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22176 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22177
22178 @table @code
22179 @kindex maint agent
22180 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22181 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22182 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22183 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22184
22185 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22186 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22187 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22188 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22189 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22190 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22191 is shown:
22192
22193 @table @code
22194 @item breakpoint
22195 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22196
22197 @item watchpoint
22198 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22199
22200 @item longjmp
22201 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22202 @code{longjmp} calls.
22203
22204 @item longjmp resume
22205 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22206
22207 @item until
22208 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22209
22210 @item finish
22211 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22212
22213 @item shlib events
22214 Shared library events.
22215
22216 @end table
22217
22218 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22219 @item maint check-symtabs
22220 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22221
22222 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22223 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22224 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22225
22226 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22227 @item maint cplus namespace
22228 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22229
22230 @kindex maint demangle
22231 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22232 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22233
22234 @kindex maint deprecate
22235 @kindex maint undeprecate
22236 @cindex deprecated commands
22237 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22238 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22239 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22240 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22241 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22242 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22243 the replacement as part of the warning.
22244
22245 @kindex maint dump-me
22246 @item maint dump-me
22247 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22248 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22249 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22250 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22251
22252 @kindex maint internal-error
22253 @kindex maint internal-warning
22254 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22255 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22256 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22257 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22258 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22259 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22260 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22261 @value{GDBN} session.
22262
22263 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22264 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22265
22266 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22267
22268 @smallexample
22269 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22270 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22271 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22272 debugging may prove unreliable.
22273 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22274 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22275 (@value{GDBP})
22276 @end smallexample
22277
22278 @kindex maint packet
22279 @item maint packet @var{text}
22280 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22281 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22282 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22283 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22284 checksum.
22285
22286 @kindex maint print architecture
22287 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22288 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22289 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22290
22291 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22292 @item maint print dummy-frames
22293 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22294
22295 @smallexample
22296 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22297 @dots{}
22298 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22299 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22300 58 return (a + b);
22301 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22302 @dots{}
22303 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22304 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22305 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22306 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22307 (@value{GDBP})
22308 @end smallexample
22309
22310 Takes an optional file parameter.
22311
22312 @kindex maint print registers
22313 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22314 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22315 @kindex maint print register-groups
22316 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22317 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22318 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22319 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22320 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22321
22322 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22323 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22324 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22325 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22326 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22327 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22328
22329 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22330 write the information.
22331
22332 @kindex maint print reggroups
22333 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22334 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22335 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22336 information.
22337
22338 The register groups info looks like this:
22339
22340 @smallexample
22341 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22342 Group Type
22343 general user
22344 float user
22345 all user
22346 vector user
22347 system user
22348 save internal
22349 restore internal
22350 @end smallexample
22351
22352 @kindex flushregs
22353 @item flushregs
22354 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22355
22356 @kindex maint print objfiles
22357 @cindex info for known object files
22358 @item maint print objfiles
22359 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22360 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22361 and symtabs.
22362
22363 @kindex maint print statistics
22364 @cindex bcache statistics
22365 @item maint print statistics
22366 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22367 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22368 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22369 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22370 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22371 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22372 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22373 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22374 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22375 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22376 lengths.
22377
22378 @kindex maint print target-stack
22379 @cindex target stack description
22380 @item maint print target-stack
22381 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
22382 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
22383 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
22384 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
22385 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
22386 address.
22387
22388 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
22389 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
22390
22391 @kindex maint print type
22392 @cindex type chain of a data type
22393 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22394 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22395 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22396 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22397 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22398 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22399
22400 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22401 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22402 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22403 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22404 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22405
22406 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22407 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22408 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22409 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22410 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22411 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22412 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22413 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22414 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22415
22416 @kindex maint set profile
22417 @kindex maint show profile
22418 @cindex profiling GDB
22419 @item maint set profile
22420 @itemx maint show profile
22421 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22422
22423 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22424 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22425 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22426 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22427 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22428 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22429 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22430
22431 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22432 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22433
22434 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22435 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22436 @item maint show-debug-regs
22437 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22438 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22439 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
22440 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22441 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22442
22443 @kindex maint space
22444 @cindex memory used by commands
22445 @item maint space
22446 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22447 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22448 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22449 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22450 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22451
22452 @kindex maint time
22453 @cindex time of command execution
22454 @item maint time
22455 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22456 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22457 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22458 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22459 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22460
22461 @kindex maint translate-address
22462 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22463 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22464 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22465 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22466 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22467 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22468 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22469
22470 @end table
22471
22472 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22473 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22474
22475 @table @code
22476 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22477 @kindex set watchdog
22478 @cindex watchdog timer
22479 @cindex timeout for commands
22480 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22481 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22482 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22483
22484 @item show watchdog
22485 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22486 @end table
22487
22488 @node Remote Protocol
22489 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22490
22491 @menu
22492 * Overview::
22493 * Packets::
22494 * Stop Reply Packets::
22495 * General Query Packets::
22496 * Register Packet Format::
22497 * Tracepoint Packets::
22498 * Interrupts::
22499 * Examples::
22500 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
22501 * Memory Map Format::
22502 @end menu
22503
22504 @node Overview
22505 @section Overview
22506
22507 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22508 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22509 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22510 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22511
22512 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22513 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22514
22515 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22516 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22517 @cindex remote serial protocol
22518 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22519 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22520 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22521 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22522
22523 @smallexample
22524 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22525 @end smallexample
22526 @noindent
22527
22528 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22529 @noindent
22530 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22531 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22532 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22533
22534 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22535 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22536
22537 @smallexample
22538 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22539 @end smallexample
22540
22541 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22542 @noindent
22543 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22544 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22545 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22546
22547 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22548 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22549 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22550 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22551 retransmission):
22552
22553 @smallexample
22554 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22555 <- @code{+}
22556 @end smallexample
22557 @noindent
22558
22559 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22560 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22561 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22562 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22563
22564 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22565 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22566 exceptions).
22567
22568 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22569 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22570 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22571 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22572
22573 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22574 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22575 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22576
22577 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22578 @anchor{Binary Data}
22579 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22580 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22581 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22582 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22583 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22584 binary data.
22585
22586 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22587 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22588 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22589 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22590 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22591 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22592 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22593 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22594 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22595 (described next).
22596
22597 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22598 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22599 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22600 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22601 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22602 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22603 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22604
22605 So:
22606 @smallexample
22607 "@code{0* }"
22608 @end smallexample
22609 @noindent
22610 means the same as "0000".
22611
22612 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22613 error number. That number is not well defined.
22614
22615 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22616 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22617 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22618 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22619 on that response.
22620
22621 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22622 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22623 optional.
22624
22625 @node Packets
22626 @section Packets
22627
22628 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22629 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22630 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
22631 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22632
22633 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22634 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22635 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22636 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22637 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22638 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22639 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22640 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
22641 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22642 @var{baz}.
22643
22644 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22645 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22646
22647 Here are the packet descriptions.
22648
22649 @table @samp
22650
22651 @item !
22652 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22653 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22654 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22655 debugged.
22656
22657 Reply:
22658 @table @samp
22659 @item OK
22660 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22661 @end table
22662
22663 @item ?
22664 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22665 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22666 step and continue.
22667
22668 Reply:
22669 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22670
22671 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22672 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22673 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22674 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22675 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22676
22677 Reply:
22678 @table @samp
22679 @item OK
22680 The arguments were set.
22681 @item E @var{NN}
22682 An error occurred.
22683 @end table
22684
22685 @item b @var{baud}
22686 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22687 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22688 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22689
22690 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22691 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22692 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22693
22694 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22695 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22696 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22697 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22698 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22699
22700 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22701 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22702 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22703 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22704
22705 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22706 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22707
22708 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22709 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22710 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22711 resume at current address.
22712
22713 Reply:
22714 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22715
22716 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22717 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22718 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22719 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22720
22721 Reply:
22722 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22723
22724 @item d
22725 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22726 Toggle debug flag.
22727
22728 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22729 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22730
22731 @item D
22732 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22733 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22734 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22735
22736 Reply:
22737 @table @samp
22738 @item OK
22739 for success
22740 @item E @var{NN}
22741 for an error
22742 @end table
22743
22744 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22745 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22746 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22747 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22748 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
22749
22750 @item g
22751 @anchor{read registers packet}
22752 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22753 Read general registers.
22754
22755 Reply:
22756 @table @samp
22757 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22758 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22759 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22760 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22761 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22762 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22763 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22764 @item E @var{NN}
22765 for an error.
22766 @end table
22767
22768 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22769 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22770 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22771 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22772
22773 Reply:
22774 @table @samp
22775 @item OK
22776 for success
22777 @item E @var{NN}
22778 for an error
22779 @end table
22780
22781 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22782 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22783 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22784 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22785 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22786 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22787 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22788
22789 Reply:
22790 @table @samp
22791 @item OK
22792 for success
22793 @item E @var{NN}
22794 for an error
22795 @end table
22796
22797 @c FIXME: JTC:
22798 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22799 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22800 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22801 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22802 @c described. For example:
22803 @c
22804 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22805 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22806 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22807 @c
22808 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22809 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22810 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22811
22812 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22813 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22814 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22815 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22816 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22817 step starting at that address.
22818
22819 @item I
22820 @cindex @samp{I} packet
22821 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22822 step packet}.
22823
22824 @item k
22825 @cindex @samp{k} packet
22826 Kill request.
22827
22828 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22829 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22830 thread?)}.
22831
22832 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
22833 @cindex @samp{m} packet
22834 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22835 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
22836
22837 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
22838 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
22839 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
22840 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
22841 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
22842 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
22843 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
22844 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
22845
22846 Reply:
22847 @table @samp
22848 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22849 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
22850 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
22851 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
22852 @item E @var{NN}
22853 @var{NN} is errno
22854 @end table
22855
22856 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22857 @cindex @samp{M} packet
22858 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22859 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
22860 hexadecimal number.
22861
22862 Reply:
22863 @table @samp
22864 @item OK
22865 for success
22866 @item E @var{NN}
22867 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
22868 written).
22869 @end table
22870
22871 @item p @var{n}
22872 @cindex @samp{p} packet
22873 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
22874 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
22875 register value is encoded.
22876
22877 Reply:
22878 @table @samp
22879 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22880 the register's value
22881 @item E @var{NN}
22882 for an error
22883 @item
22884 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22885 @end table
22886
22887 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
22888 @anchor{write register packet}
22889 @cindex @samp{P} packet
22890 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
22891 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
22892 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
22893
22894 Reply:
22895 @table @samp
22896 @item OK
22897 for success
22898 @item E @var{NN}
22899 for an error
22900 @end table
22901
22902 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22903 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22904 @cindex @samp{q} packet
22905 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
22906 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
22907 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
22908
22909 @item r
22910 @cindex @samp{r} packet
22911 Reset the entire system.
22912
22913 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
22914
22915 @item R @var{XX}
22916 @cindex @samp{R} packet
22917 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
22918 This packet is only available in extended mode.
22919
22920 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
22921
22922 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22923 @cindex @samp{s} packet
22924 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
22925 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
22926
22927 Reply:
22928 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22929
22930 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22931 @anchor{step with signal packet}
22932 @cindex @samp{S} packet
22933 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
22934 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
22935
22936 Reply:
22937 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22938
22939 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
22940 @cindex @samp{t} packet
22941 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
22942 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
22943 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
22944
22945 @item T @var{XX}
22946 @cindex @samp{T} packet
22947 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
22948
22949 Reply:
22950 @table @samp
22951 @item OK
22952 thread is still alive
22953 @item E @var{NN}
22954 thread is dead
22955 @end table
22956
22957 @item v
22958 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
22959 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
22960
22961 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
22962 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
22963 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
22964 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
22965 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
22966 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
22967 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
22968 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
22969
22970 @table @samp
22971 @item c
22972 Continue.
22973 @item C @var{sig}
22974 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22975 @item s
22976 Step.
22977 @item S @var{sig}
22978 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22979 @end table
22980
22981 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
22982 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
22983
22984 Reply:
22985 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22986
22987 @item vCont?
22988 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
22989 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
22990
22991 Reply:
22992 @table @samp
22993 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
22994 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
22995 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
22996 @item
22997 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
22998 @end table
22999
23000 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23001 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23002 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23003 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23004 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23005 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23006 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23007 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23008 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23009 packet is received.
23010
23011 Reply:
23012 @table @samp
23013 @item OK
23014 for success
23015 @item E @var{NN}
23016 for an error
23017 @end table
23018
23019 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23020 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23021 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23022 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23023 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23024 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23025 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23026 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23027 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23028 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23029 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23030 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23031
23032
23033 Reply:
23034 @table @samp
23035 @item OK
23036 for success
23037 @item E.memtype
23038 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23039 @item E @var{NN}
23040 for an error
23041 @end table
23042
23043 @item vFlashDone
23044 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23045 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23046 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23047 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23048 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23049 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23050 request is completed.
23051
23052 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23053 @anchor{X packet}
23054 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23055 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23056 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23057 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23058
23059 Reply:
23060 @table @samp
23061 @item OK
23062 for success
23063 @item E @var{NN}
23064 for an error
23065 @end table
23066
23067 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23068 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23069 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23070 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23071 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23072 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23073 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23074 @var{length} bytes.
23075
23076 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23077 separately.
23078
23079 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23080 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23081 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23082 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23083 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23084 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23085
23086 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23087 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23088 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23089 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23090 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23091 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23092
23093 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23094 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23095 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23096 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23097 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23098
23099 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23100 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23101 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23102 target, is not defined.}
23103
23104 Reply:
23105 @table @samp
23106 @item OK
23107 success
23108 @item
23109 not supported
23110 @item E @var{NN}
23111 for an error
23112 @end table
23113
23114 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23115 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23116 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23117 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23118 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23119 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23120
23121 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23122 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23123
23124 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23125 movement.}
23126
23127 Reply:
23128 @table @samp
23129 @item OK
23130 success
23131 @item
23132 not supported
23133 @item E @var{NN}
23134 for an error
23135 @end table
23136
23137 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23138 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23139 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23140 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23141 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23142
23143 Reply:
23144 @table @samp
23145 @item OK
23146 success
23147 @item
23148 not supported
23149 @item E @var{NN}
23150 for an error
23151 @end table
23152
23153 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23154 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23155 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23156 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23157 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23158
23159 Reply:
23160 @table @samp
23161 @item OK
23162 success
23163 @item
23164 not supported
23165 @item E @var{NN}
23166 for an error
23167 @end table
23168
23169 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23170 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23171 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23172 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23173 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23174
23175 Reply:
23176 @table @samp
23177 @item OK
23178 success
23179 @item
23180 not supported
23181 @item E @var{NN}
23182 for an error
23183 @end table
23184
23185 @end table
23186
23187 @node Stop Reply Packets
23188 @section Stop Reply Packets
23189 @cindex stop reply packets
23190
23191 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23192 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23193 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23194 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23195 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23196 @value{GDBN} source code.
23197
23198 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23199 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23200 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23201 components.
23202
23203 @table @samp
23204
23205 @item S @var{AA}
23206 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23207 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23208 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23209
23210 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23211 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23212 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23213 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23214 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23215 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23216 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23217 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23218 @enumerate
23219 @item
23220 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23221 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23222 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23223 two-digit hex number.
23224 @item
23225 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23226 hex.
23227 @item
23228 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23229 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23230 hex.
23231 @item
23232 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23233 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23234 future.
23235 @end enumerate
23236
23237 @item W @var{AA}
23238 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23239 applicable to certain targets.
23240
23241 @item X @var{AA}
23242 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23243
23244 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23245 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23246 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23247 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23248 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23249
23250 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23251 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23252 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23253 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23254 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
23255 system calls.
23256
23257 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23258 this very system call.
23259
23260 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23261 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23262 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23263 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23264 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
23265 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
23266
23267 @end table
23268
23269 @node General Query Packets
23270 @section General Query Packets
23271 @cindex remote query requests
23272
23273 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23274 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23275 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23276 sending information to and from the stub.
23277
23278 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23279 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23280 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23281 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23282 conventions:
23283
23284 @itemize @bullet
23285 @item
23286 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23287 @item
23288 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23289 letter.
23290 @item
23291 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23292 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23293 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23294 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23295 @end itemize
23296
23297 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23298 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23299 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23300 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23301 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23302 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23303 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23304 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23305 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23306 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23307 packet.}.
23308
23309 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23310 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23311 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23312 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23313 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23314
23315 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23316
23317 @table @samp
23318
23319 @item qC
23320 @cindex current thread, remote request
23321 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23322 Return the current thread id.
23323
23324 Reply:
23325 @table @samp
23326 @item QC @var{pid}
23327 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23328 @item @r{(anything else)}
23329 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23330 @end table
23331
23332 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23333 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23334 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23335 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23336 Reply:
23337 @table @samp
23338 @item E @var{NN}
23339 An error (such as memory fault)
23340 @item C @var{crc32}
23341 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23342 @end table
23343
23344 @item qfThreadInfo
23345 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23346 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23347 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23348 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23349 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23350 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23351 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23352 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23353 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23354 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23355
23356 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23357
23358 Reply:
23359 @table @samp
23360 @item m @var{id}
23361 A single thread id
23362 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23363 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23364 @item l
23365 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23366 @end table
23367
23368 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23369 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23370 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23371 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23372 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23373
23374 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23375 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23376 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23377 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23378 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23379
23380 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23381 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23382
23383 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23384 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23385 information associated with the variable.)
23386
23387 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
23388 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23389 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23390 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23391 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23392 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23393
23394 Reply:
23395 @table @samp
23396 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23397 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23398 local storage requested.
23399
23400 @item E @var{nn}
23401 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23402
23403 @item
23404 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23405 @end table
23406
23407 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23408 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23409 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23410 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23411 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23412 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23413 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23414
23415 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23416
23417 Reply:
23418 @table @samp
23419 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23420 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23421 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23422 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23423 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23424 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23425 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23426 @end table
23427
23428 @item qOffsets
23429 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23430 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23431 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23432 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23433 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23434 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23435
23436 Reply:
23437 @table @samp
23438 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23439 @end table
23440
23441 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23442 @cindex thread information, remote request
23443 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23444 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23445 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23446
23447 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23448 (see below).
23449
23450 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23451
23452 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23453 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23454 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23455 @anchor{QPassSignals}
23456 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23457 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23458 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23459 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23460 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23461 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23462 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23463 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23464 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23465
23466 Reply:
23467 @table @samp
23468 @item OK
23469 The request succeeded.
23470
23471 @item E @var{nn}
23472 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23473
23474 @item
23475 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23476 the stub.
23477 @end table
23478
23479 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23480 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23481 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23482 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23483
23484 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23485 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23486 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23487 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23488 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23489 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23490 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23491 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23492 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23493
23494 Reply:
23495 @table @samp
23496 @item OK
23497 A command response with no output.
23498 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23499 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23500 @item E @var{NN}
23501 Indicate a badly formed request.
23502 @item
23503 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23504 @end table
23505
23506 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23507 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23508 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23509 packets.)
23510
23511 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23512 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23513 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23514 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23515 @anchor{qSupported}
23516 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23517 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23518 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23519 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23520 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23521 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23522 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23523 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23524 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23525 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23526 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23527 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23528 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23529 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23530
23531 Reply:
23532 @table @samp
23533 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23534 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23535 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23536 possible forms).
23537 @item
23538 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23539 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23540 @end table
23541
23542 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23543 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23544 are:
23545
23546 @table @samp
23547 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23548 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23549 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23550 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23551 @item @var{name}+
23552 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23553 need an associated value.
23554 @item @var{name}-
23555 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23556 @item @var{name}?
23557 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23558 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23559 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23560 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23561 @end table
23562
23563 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23564 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23565 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23566 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23567 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23568
23569 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23570 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23571 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23572 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23573 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23574 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23575 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23576 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23577 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23578 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23579 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23580 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23581 all the features it supports.
23582
23583 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23584 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23585
23586 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23587 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23588 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23589 form response.
23590
23591 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23592 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23593 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23594 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23595
23596 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23597 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23598 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23599 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23600 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23601
23602 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23603
23604 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
23605 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23606 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23607 @item Feature Name
23608 @tab Value Required
23609 @tab Default
23610 @tab Probe Allowed
23611
23612 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23613 @tab Yes
23614 @tab @samp{-}
23615 @tab No
23616
23617 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23618 @tab No
23619 @tab @samp{-}
23620 @tab Yes
23621
23622 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
23623 @tab No
23624 @tab @samp{-}
23625 @tab Yes
23626
23627 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23628 @tab No
23629 @tab @samp{-}
23630 @tab Yes
23631
23632 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
23633 @tab No
23634 @tab @samp{-}
23635 @tab Yes
23636
23637 @end multitable
23638
23639 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23640
23641 @table @samp
23642 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23643 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23644 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23645 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23646 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23647 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23648 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23649 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23650 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23651 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23652
23653 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23654 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23655 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23656
23657 @item qXfer:features:read
23658 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
23659 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
23660
23661 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
23662 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
23663 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
23664
23665 @item QPassSignals
23666 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23667 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
23668
23669 @end table
23670
23671 @item qSymbol::
23672 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23673 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23674 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23675 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23676
23677 Reply:
23678 @table @samp
23679 @item OK
23680 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23681 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23682 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23683 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23684 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23685 below.
23686 @end table
23687
23688 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23689 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23690
23691 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23692 target has previously requested.
23693
23694 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23695 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23696 will be empty.
23697
23698 Reply:
23699 @table @samp
23700 @item OK
23701 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23702 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23703 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23704 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23705 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23706 @end table
23707
23708 @item QTDP
23709 @itemx QTFrame
23710 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23711
23712 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23713 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23714 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23715 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23716 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23717 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23718 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23719 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23720 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23721 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23722
23723 Reply:
23724 @table @samp
23725 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23726 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23727 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23728 the thread's attributes.
23729 @end table
23730
23731 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23732 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23733 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23734 packets.)
23735
23736 @item QTStart
23737 @itemx QTStop
23738 @itemx QTinit
23739 @itemx QTro
23740 @itemx qTStatus
23741 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23742
23743 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23744 @cindex read special object, remote request
23745 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23746 @anchor{qXfer read}
23747 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23748 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23749 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23750 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
23751 additional details about what data to access.
23752
23753 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23754 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23755 formats, listed below.
23756
23757 @table @samp
23758 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23759 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23760 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23761 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23762
23763 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23764 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23765
23766 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23767 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
23768 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
23769 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
23770 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
23771
23772 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23773 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23774
23775 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23776 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
23777 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
23778 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23779 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23780
23781 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23782 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23783 @end table
23784
23785 Reply:
23786 @table @samp
23787 @item m @var{data}
23788 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23789 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23790 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23791 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23792 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23793 request.
23794
23795 @item l @var{data}
23796 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
23797 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
23798 than the @var{length} in the request.
23799
23800 @item l
23801 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23802 There is no more data to be read.
23803
23804 @item E00
23805 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23806
23807 @item E @var{nn}
23808 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23809 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23810
23811 @item
23812 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
23813 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
23814 @end table
23815
23816 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23817 @cindex write data into object, remote request
23818 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
23819 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
23820 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
23821 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
23822 is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
23823 to access.
23824
23825 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
23826 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
23827 specific request specifications ought to use.
23828
23829 Reply:
23830 @table @samp
23831 @item @var{nn}
23832 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
23833 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
23834
23835 @item E00
23836 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23837
23838 @item E @var{nn}
23839 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
23840 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23841
23842 @item
23843 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
23844 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
23845 @end table
23846
23847 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
23848 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
23849 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
23850 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
23851 must respond with an empty packet.
23852
23853 @end table
23854
23855 @node Register Packet Format
23856 @section Register Packet Format
23857
23858 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
23859 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23860 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23861 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
23862 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
23863 most-significant - least-significant.
23864
23865 @table @r
23866
23867 @item MIPS32
23868
23869 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
23870 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
23871 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
23872
23873 @item MIPS64
23874
23875 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
23876 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
23877 as @code{MIPS32}.
23878
23879 @end table
23880
23881 @node Tracepoint Packets
23882 @section Tracepoint Packets
23883 @cindex tracepoint packets
23884 @cindex packets, tracepoint
23885
23886 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
23887 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
23888
23889 @table @samp
23890
23891 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
23892 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
23893 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
23894 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
23895 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
23896 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
23897 tracepoint's actions.
23898
23899 Replies:
23900 @table @samp
23901 @item OK
23902 The packet was understood and carried out.
23903 @item
23904 The packet was not recognized.
23905 @end table
23906
23907 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
23908 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
23909 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
23910 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
23911 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
23912 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
23913 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
23914
23915 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
23916 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
23917 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
23918 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
23919 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
23920 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
23921 tracepoint actions.
23922
23923 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
23924 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
23925 following forms:
23926
23927 @table @samp
23928
23929 @item R @var{mask}
23930 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
23931 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
23932 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
23933 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
23934 not fit in a 32-bit word.
23935
23936 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
23937 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
23938 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
23939 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
23940 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
23941 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
23942 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
23943
23944 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
23945 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
23946 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
23947 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
23948 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
23949 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
23950 packet).
23951
23952 @end table
23953
23954 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
23955 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
23956 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
23957 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
23958 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
23959 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
23960 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
23961 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
23962
23963 Replies:
23964 @table @samp
23965 @item OK
23966 The packet was understood and carried out.
23967 @item
23968 The packet was not recognized.
23969 @end table
23970
23971 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
23972 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
23973 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
23974 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
23975
23976 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
23977 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
23978 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
23979 one of the following forms:
23980
23981 @table @samp
23982 @item F @var{f}
23983 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
23984 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
23985 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
23986
23987 @item T @var{t}
23988 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
23989 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
23990
23991 @end table
23992
23993 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
23994 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23995 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
23996 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
23997
23998 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
23999 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24000 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24001 is a hexadecimal number.
24002
24003 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24004 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24005 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24006 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24007 numbers.
24008
24009 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24010 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24011 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24012
24013 @item QTStart
24014 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24015 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24016
24017 @item QTStop
24018 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24019
24020 @item QTinit
24021 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24022
24023 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24024 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24025 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24026 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24027
24028 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24029 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24030 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24031 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24032
24033 @item qTStatus
24034 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24035
24036 Replies:
24037 @table @samp
24038 @item T0
24039 There is no trace experiment running.
24040 @item T1
24041 There is a trace experiment running.
24042 @end table
24043
24044 @end table
24045
24046
24047 @node Interrupts
24048 @section Interrupts
24049 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24050
24051 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24052 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24053 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24054 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24055
24056 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24057 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24058 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24059 interfaces.
24060
24061 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24062 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24063 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24064 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24065 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24066 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24067 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24068 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24069
24070 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24071 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24072 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24073 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24074 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24075 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24076 program is stopped will be discarded.
24077
24078 @node Examples
24079 @section Examples
24080
24081 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24082 does not get any direct output:
24083
24084 @smallexample
24085 -> @code{R00}
24086 <- @code{+}
24087 @emph{target restarts}
24088 -> @code{?}
24089 <- @code{+}
24090 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24091 -> @code{+}
24092 @end smallexample
24093
24094 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24095
24096 @smallexample
24097 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24098 <- @code{+}
24099 -> @code{s}
24100 <- @code{+}
24101 @emph{time passes}
24102 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24103 -> @code{+}
24104 -> @code{g}
24105 <- @code{+}
24106 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24107 -> @code{+}
24108 @end smallexample
24109
24110 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24111 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24112 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24113
24114 @menu
24115 * File-I/O Overview::
24116 * Protocol Basics::
24117 * The F Request Packet::
24118 * The F Reply Packet::
24119 * The Ctrl-C Message::
24120 * Console I/O::
24121 * List of Supported Calls::
24122 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
24123 * Constants::
24124 * File-I/O Examples::
24125 @end menu
24126
24127 @node File-I/O Overview
24128 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24129 @cindex file-i/o overview
24130
24131 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24132 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24133 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24134 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24135 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24136 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24137
24138 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24139 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24140 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24141 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24142 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24143
24144 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24145 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24146 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24147 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24148 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24149 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24150 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24151
24152 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24153 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24154 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24155 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24156 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24157
24158 @smallexample
24159 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24160 <- target requests 'system call X'
24161 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24162 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
24163 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
24164 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24165 @end smallexample
24166
24167 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24168 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24169 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24170 system are not supported by this protocol.
24171
24172 @node Protocol Basics
24173 @subsection Protocol Basics
24174 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24175
24176 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24177 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24178 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24179 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24180 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24181 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24182 to call the appropriate host system call:
24183
24184 @itemize @bullet
24185 @item
24186 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24187
24188 @item
24189 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24190 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24191 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24192 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
24193
24194 @end itemize
24195
24196 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24197
24198 @itemize @bullet
24199 @item
24200 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24201 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24202 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24203 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24204 packet.
24205
24206 @item
24207 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24208 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24209
24210 @item
24211 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24212
24213 @item
24214 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24215
24216 @item
24217 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24218 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24219 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24220 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24221 packet.
24222
24223 @end itemize
24224
24225 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24226 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24227
24228 @itemize @bullet
24229 @item
24230 Return value.
24231
24232 @item
24233 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24234
24235 @item
24236 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24237
24238 @end itemize
24239
24240 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24241 the latest continue or step action.
24242
24243 @node The F Request Packet
24244 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
24245 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24246 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24247
24248 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24249
24250 @table @samp
24251 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24252
24253 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24254 This is just the name of the function.
24255
24256 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24257 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24258 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24259 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24260 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24261 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24262 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24263
24264 @end table
24265
24266
24267
24268 @node The F Reply Packet
24269 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
24270 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24271 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24272
24273 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24274
24275 @table @samp
24276
24277 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific
24278 attachment}
24279
24280 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24281
24282 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
24283 representation.
24284 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24285
24286 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24287 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24288 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24289
24290 @smallexample
24291 F0,0,C
24292 @end smallexample
24293
24294 @noindent
24295 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24296
24297 @smallexample
24298 F-1,4,C
24299 @end smallexample
24300
24301 @noindent
24302 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24303
24304 @end table
24305
24306
24307 @node The Ctrl-C Message
24308 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
24309 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24310
24311 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24312 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
24313 the target should behave as if it had
24314 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24315 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24316 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24317 packet.
24318
24319 It's important for the target to know in which
24320 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24321
24322 @itemize @bullet
24323 @item
24324 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24325
24326 @item
24327 The system call on the host has been finished.
24328
24329 @end itemize
24330
24331 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24332 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24333 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24334 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24335 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24336 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24337
24338 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24339 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24340 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24341 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24342 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24343 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24344 or the full action has been completed.
24345
24346 @node Console I/O
24347 @subsection Console I/O
24348 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24349
24350 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
24351 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24352 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24353 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24354 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24355 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24356 conditions is met:
24357
24358 @itemize @bullet
24359 @item
24360 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24361 @code{read}
24362 system call is treated as finished.
24363
24364 @item
24365 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24366 newline.
24367
24368 @item
24369 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24370 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24371
24372 @end itemize
24373
24374 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24375 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24376 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24377 is stopped at the user's request.
24378
24379
24380 @node List of Supported Calls
24381 @subsection List of Supported Calls
24382 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24383
24384 @menu
24385 * open::
24386 * close::
24387 * read::
24388 * write::
24389 * lseek::
24390 * rename::
24391 * unlink::
24392 * stat/fstat::
24393 * gettimeofday::
24394 * isatty::
24395 * system::
24396 @end menu
24397
24398 @node open
24399 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24400 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24401
24402 @table @asis
24403 @item Synopsis:
24404 @smallexample
24405 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24406 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24407 @end smallexample
24408
24409 @item Request:
24410 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24411
24412 @noindent
24413 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24414
24415 @table @code
24416 @item O_CREAT
24417 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24418 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24419 are concerned.
24420
24421 @item O_EXCL
24422 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24423 an error and open() fails.
24424
24425 @item O_TRUNC
24426 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24427 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24428 truncated to zero length.
24429
24430 @item O_APPEND
24431 The file is opened in append mode.
24432
24433 @item O_RDONLY
24434 The file is opened for reading only.
24435
24436 @item O_WRONLY
24437 The file is opened for writing only.
24438
24439 @item O_RDWR
24440 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24441 @end table
24442
24443 @noindent
24444 Other bits are silently ignored.
24445
24446
24447 @noindent
24448 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24449
24450 @table @code
24451 @item S_IRUSR
24452 User has read permission.
24453
24454 @item S_IWUSR
24455 User has write permission.
24456
24457 @item S_IRGRP
24458 Group has read permission.
24459
24460 @item S_IWGRP
24461 Group has write permission.
24462
24463 @item S_IROTH
24464 Others have read permission.
24465
24466 @item S_IWOTH
24467 Others have write permission.
24468 @end table
24469
24470 @noindent
24471 Other bits are silently ignored.
24472
24473
24474 @item Return value:
24475 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24476 occurred.
24477
24478 @item Errors:
24479
24480 @table @code
24481 @item EEXIST
24482 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24483
24484 @item EISDIR
24485 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24486
24487 @item EACCES
24488 The requested access is not allowed.
24489
24490 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24491 @var{pathname} was too long.
24492
24493 @item ENOENT
24494 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24495
24496 @item ENODEV
24497 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24498
24499 @item EROFS
24500 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24501 write access was requested.
24502
24503 @item EFAULT
24504 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24505
24506 @item ENOSPC
24507 No space on device to create the file.
24508
24509 @item EMFILE
24510 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24511
24512 @item ENFILE
24513 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24514 has been reached.
24515
24516 @item EINTR
24517 The call was interrupted by the user.
24518 @end table
24519
24520 @end table
24521
24522 @node close
24523 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24524 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24525
24526 @table @asis
24527 @item Synopsis:
24528 @smallexample
24529 int close(int fd);
24530 @end smallexample
24531
24532 @item Request:
24533 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24534
24535 @item Return value:
24536 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24537
24538 @item Errors:
24539
24540 @table @code
24541 @item EBADF
24542 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24543
24544 @item EINTR
24545 The call was interrupted by the user.
24546 @end table
24547
24548 @end table
24549
24550 @node read
24551 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24552 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24553
24554 @table @asis
24555 @item Synopsis:
24556 @smallexample
24557 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24558 @end smallexample
24559
24560 @item Request:
24561 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24562
24563 @item Return value:
24564 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24565 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24566 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24567
24568 @item Errors:
24569
24570 @table @code
24571 @item EBADF
24572 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24573 reading.
24574
24575 @item EFAULT
24576 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24577
24578 @item EINTR
24579 The call was interrupted by the user.
24580 @end table
24581
24582 @end table
24583
24584 @node write
24585 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24586 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24587
24588 @table @asis
24589 @item Synopsis:
24590 @smallexample
24591 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24592 @end smallexample
24593
24594 @item Request:
24595 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24596
24597 @item Return value:
24598 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24599 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24600 is returned.
24601
24602 @item Errors:
24603
24604 @table @code
24605 @item EBADF
24606 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24607 writing.
24608
24609 @item EFAULT
24610 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24611
24612 @item EFBIG
24613 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24614 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
24615
24616 @item ENOSPC
24617 No space on device to write the data.
24618
24619 @item EINTR
24620 The call was interrupted by the user.
24621 @end table
24622
24623 @end table
24624
24625 @node lseek
24626 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24627 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24628
24629 @table @asis
24630 @item Synopsis:
24631 @smallexample
24632 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24633 @end smallexample
24634
24635 @item Request:
24636 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24637
24638 @var{flag} is one of:
24639
24640 @table @code
24641 @item SEEK_SET
24642 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24643
24644 @item SEEK_CUR
24645 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24646 bytes.
24647
24648 @item SEEK_END
24649 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24650 bytes.
24651 @end table
24652
24653 @item Return value:
24654 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24655 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24656 value of -1 is returned.
24657
24658 @item Errors:
24659
24660 @table @code
24661 @item EBADF
24662 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24663
24664 @item ESPIPE
24665 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24666
24667 @item EINVAL
24668 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24669
24670 @item EINTR
24671 The call was interrupted by the user.
24672 @end table
24673
24674 @end table
24675
24676 @node rename
24677 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24678 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24679
24680 @table @asis
24681 @item Synopsis:
24682 @smallexample
24683 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24684 @end smallexample
24685
24686 @item Request:
24687 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24688
24689 @item Return value:
24690 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24691
24692 @item Errors:
24693
24694 @table @code
24695 @item EISDIR
24696 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24697 directory.
24698
24699 @item EEXIST
24700 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24701
24702 @item EBUSY
24703 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24704 process.
24705
24706 @item EINVAL
24707 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24708 of itself.
24709
24710 @item ENOTDIR
24711 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24712 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24713 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24714
24715 @item EFAULT
24716 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24717
24718 @item EACCES
24719 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24720
24721 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24722
24723 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24724
24725 @item ENOENT
24726 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24727
24728 @item EROFS
24729 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24730
24731 @item ENOSPC
24732 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24733 directory entry.
24734
24735 @item EINTR
24736 The call was interrupted by the user.
24737 @end table
24738
24739 @end table
24740
24741 @node unlink
24742 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24743 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24744
24745 @table @asis
24746 @item Synopsis:
24747 @smallexample
24748 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24749 @end smallexample
24750
24751 @item Request:
24752 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24753
24754 @item Return value:
24755 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24756
24757 @item Errors:
24758
24759 @table @code
24760 @item EACCES
24761 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24762
24763 @item EPERM
24764 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24765
24766 @item EBUSY
24767 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24768 being used by another process.
24769
24770 @item EFAULT
24771 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24772
24773 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24774 @var{pathname} was too long.
24775
24776 @item ENOENT
24777 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24778
24779 @item ENOTDIR
24780 A component of the path is not a directory.
24781
24782 @item EROFS
24783 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24784
24785 @item EINTR
24786 The call was interrupted by the user.
24787 @end table
24788
24789 @end table
24790
24791 @node stat/fstat
24792 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24793 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24794 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24795
24796 @table @asis
24797 @item Synopsis:
24798 @smallexample
24799 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24800 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24801 @end smallexample
24802
24803 @item Request:
24804 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
24805 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
24806
24807 @item Return value:
24808 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24809
24810 @item Errors:
24811
24812 @table @code
24813 @item EBADF
24814 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
24815
24816 @item ENOENT
24817 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
24818 path is an empty string.
24819
24820 @item ENOTDIR
24821 A component of the path is not a directory.
24822
24823 @item EFAULT
24824 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24825
24826 @item EACCES
24827 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24828
24829 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24830 @var{pathname} was too long.
24831
24832 @item EINTR
24833 The call was interrupted by the user.
24834 @end table
24835
24836 @end table
24837
24838 @node gettimeofday
24839 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
24840 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
24841
24842 @table @asis
24843 @item Synopsis:
24844 @smallexample
24845 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
24846 @end smallexample
24847
24848 @item Request:
24849 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
24850
24851 @item Return value:
24852 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
24853
24854 @item Errors:
24855
24856 @table @code
24857 @item EINVAL
24858 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
24859
24860 @item EFAULT
24861 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24862 @end table
24863
24864 @end table
24865
24866 @node isatty
24867 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
24868 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
24869
24870 @table @asis
24871 @item Synopsis:
24872 @smallexample
24873 int isatty(int fd);
24874 @end smallexample
24875
24876 @item Request:
24877 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
24878
24879 @item Return value:
24880 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
24881
24882 @item Errors:
24883
24884 @table @code
24885 @item EINTR
24886 The call was interrupted by the user.
24887 @end table
24888
24889 @end table
24890
24891 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
24892 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
24893 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
24894 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
24895 needed.
24896
24897
24898 @node system
24899 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
24900 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
24901
24902 @table @asis
24903 @item Synopsis:
24904 @smallexample
24905 int system(const char *command);
24906 @end smallexample
24907
24908 @item Request:
24909 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
24910
24911 @item Return value:
24912 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
24913 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
24914 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
24915 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
24916 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
24917 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
24918 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
24919
24920 @item Errors:
24921
24922 @table @code
24923 @item EINTR
24924 The call was interrupted by the user.
24925 @end table
24926
24927 @end table
24928
24929 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
24930 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
24931 the host is simplified before it's returned
24932 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
24933 is discarded, and the return value consists
24934 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
24935
24936 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
24937 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
24938 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
24939
24940 @table @code
24941 @item set remote system-call-allowed
24942 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
24943 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
24944 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
24945
24946 @item show remote system-call-allowed
24947 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
24948 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
24949 protocol.
24950 @end table
24951
24952 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
24953 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
24954 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
24955
24956 @menu
24957 * Integral Datatypes::
24958 * Pointer Values::
24959 * Memory Transfer::
24960 * struct stat::
24961 * struct timeval::
24962 @end menu
24963
24964 @node Integral Datatypes
24965 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
24966 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
24967
24968 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
24969 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
24970 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
24971
24972 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
24973 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
24974
24975 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
24976
24977 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
24978 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
24979
24980 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
24981
24982 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
24983 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
24984 byte order.
24985
24986 @node Pointer Values
24987 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
24988 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
24989
24990 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
24991 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
24992 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
24993 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
24994
24995 @smallexample
24996 @code{1aaf/12}
24997 @end smallexample
24998
24999 @noindent
25000 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25001 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25002 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25003 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25004
25005 @smallexample
25006 @code{123456/d}
25007 @end smallexample
25008
25009 @node Memory Transfer
25010 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
25011 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25012
25013 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25014 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
25015 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25016 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25017 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25018 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25019 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25020
25021
25022 @node struct stat
25023 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25024 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25025
25026 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25027 is defined as follows:
25028
25029 @smallexample
25030 struct stat @{
25031 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25032 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25033 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25034 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25035 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25036 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25037 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25038 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25039 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25040 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25041 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25042 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25043 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25044 @};
25045 @end smallexample
25046
25047 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25048 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25049 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25050
25051 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25052 range of values.
25053
25054 @table @code
25055
25056 @item st_dev
25057 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25058
25059 @item st_ino
25060 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25061
25062 @item st_mode
25063 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25064 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25065
25066 @item st_uid
25067 @itemx st_gid
25068 @itemx st_rdev
25069 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25070
25071 @item st_atime
25072 @itemx st_mtime
25073 @itemx st_ctime
25074 These values have a host and file system dependent
25075 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25076 support exact timing values.
25077 @end table
25078
25079 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25080 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25081 continuing.
25082
25083 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25084 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25085 get truncated on the target.
25086
25087 @node struct timeval
25088 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25089 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25090
25091 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25092 is defined as follows:
25093
25094 @smallexample
25095 struct timeval @{
25096 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25097 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25098 @};
25099 @end smallexample
25100
25101 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25102 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25103 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25104
25105 @node Constants
25106 @subsection Constants
25107 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25108
25109 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25110 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25111 values before and after the call as needed.
25112
25113 @menu
25114 * Open Flags::
25115 * mode_t Values::
25116 * Errno Values::
25117 * Lseek Flags::
25118 * Limits::
25119 @end menu
25120
25121 @node Open Flags
25122 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
25123 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25124
25125 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25126
25127 @smallexample
25128 O_RDONLY 0x0
25129 O_WRONLY 0x1
25130 O_RDWR 0x2
25131 O_APPEND 0x8
25132 O_CREAT 0x200
25133 O_TRUNC 0x400
25134 O_EXCL 0x800
25135 @end smallexample
25136
25137 @node mode_t Values
25138 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
25139 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25140
25141 All values are given in octal representation.
25142
25143 @smallexample
25144 S_IFREG 0100000
25145 S_IFDIR 040000
25146 S_IRUSR 0400
25147 S_IWUSR 0200
25148 S_IXUSR 0100
25149 S_IRGRP 040
25150 S_IWGRP 020
25151 S_IXGRP 010
25152 S_IROTH 04
25153 S_IWOTH 02
25154 S_IXOTH 01
25155 @end smallexample
25156
25157 @node Errno Values
25158 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
25159 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25160
25161 All values are given in decimal representation.
25162
25163 @smallexample
25164 EPERM 1
25165 ENOENT 2
25166 EINTR 4
25167 EBADF 9
25168 EACCES 13
25169 EFAULT 14
25170 EBUSY 16
25171 EEXIST 17
25172 ENODEV 19
25173 ENOTDIR 20
25174 EISDIR 21
25175 EINVAL 22
25176 ENFILE 23
25177 EMFILE 24
25178 EFBIG 27
25179 ENOSPC 28
25180 ESPIPE 29
25181 EROFS 30
25182 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25183 EUNKNOWN 9999
25184 @end smallexample
25185
25186 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25187 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25188
25189 @node Lseek Flags
25190 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
25191 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25192
25193 @smallexample
25194 SEEK_SET 0
25195 SEEK_CUR 1
25196 SEEK_END 2
25197 @end smallexample
25198
25199 @node Limits
25200 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25201 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25202
25203 All values are given in decimal representation.
25204
25205 @smallexample
25206 INT_MIN -2147483648
25207 INT_MAX 2147483647
25208 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25209 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25210 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25211 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25212 @end smallexample
25213
25214 @node File-I/O Examples
25215 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25216 @cindex file-i/o examples
25217
25218 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25219 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25220
25221 @smallexample
25222 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25223 @emph{request memory read from target}
25224 -> @code{m1234,6}
25225 <- XXXXXX
25226 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25227 -> @code{F6}
25228 @end smallexample
25229
25230 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25231 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25232
25233 @smallexample
25234 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25235 @emph{request memory write to target}
25236 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25237 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25238 -> @code{F6}
25239 @end smallexample
25240
25241 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25242 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25243
25244 @smallexample
25245 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25246 -> @code{F-1,9}
25247 @end smallexample
25248
25249 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25250 host is called:
25251
25252 @smallexample
25253 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25254 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25255 <- @code{T02}
25256 @end smallexample
25257
25258 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25259 host is called:
25260
25261 @smallexample
25262 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25263 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25264 <- @code{T02}
25265 @end smallexample
25266
25267 @node Memory Map Format
25268 @section Memory Map Format
25269 @cindex memory map format
25270
25271 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25272 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25273 memory map.
25274
25275 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25276 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25277 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25278
25279 @smallexample
25280 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25281 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25282 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25283 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25284 <memory-map>
25285 region...
25286 </memory-map>
25287 @end smallexample
25288
25289 Each region can be either:
25290
25291 @itemize
25292
25293 @item
25294 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25295 bytes from there:
25296
25297 @smallexample
25298 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25299 @end smallexample
25300
25301
25302 @item
25303 A region of read-only memory:
25304
25305 @smallexample
25306 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25307 @end smallexample
25308
25309
25310 @item
25311 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25312 bytes in length:
25313
25314 @smallexample
25315 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25316 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25317 </memory>
25318 @end smallexample
25319
25320 @end itemize
25321
25322 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25323 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25324 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25325
25326 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25327
25328 @smallexample
25329 <!-- ................................................... -->
25330 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25331 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25332 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25333 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25334 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25335 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25336 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25337 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25338 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25339 and its type, or device. -->
25340 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25341 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25342 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25343 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25344 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25345 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25346 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25347 @end smallexample
25348
25349 @include agentexpr.texi
25350
25351 @node Target Descriptions
25352 @appendix Target Descriptions
25353 @cindex target descriptions
25354
25355 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
25356 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
25357 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
25358
25359 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
25360 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
25361 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
25362 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
25363 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
25364 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
25365 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
25366
25367 @itemize @bullet
25368 @item
25369 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
25370 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
25371 @item
25372 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
25373 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
25374 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
25375 @item
25376 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
25377 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
25378 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
25379 @end itemize
25380
25381 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
25382 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
25383 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
25384 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
25385 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
25386
25387 @value{GDBN} must be compiled with Expat support to support XML target
25388 descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
25389
25390 @menu
25391 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
25392 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
25393 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
25394 descriptions.
25395 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
25396 @end menu
25397
25398 @node Retrieving Descriptions
25399 @section Retrieving Descriptions
25400
25401 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
25402 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
25403 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
25404 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
25405 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
25406 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
25407 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
25408 Format}.
25409
25410 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
25411 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
25412 specify a file are:
25413
25414 @table @code
25415 @cindex set tdesc filename
25416 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
25417 Read the target description from @var{path}.
25418
25419 @cindex unset tdesc filename
25420 @item unset tdesc filename
25421 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
25422 will use the description supplied by the current target.
25423
25424 @cindex show tdesc filename
25425 @item show tdesc filename
25426 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
25427 @end table
25428
25429
25430 @node Target Description Format
25431 @section Target Description Format
25432 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
25433
25434 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
25435 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
25436 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
25437 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
25438 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
25439 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
25440 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
25441
25442 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
25443 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
25444 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
25445 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
25446
25447 Here is a simple target description:
25448
25449 @smallexample
25450 <target>
25451 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
25452 </target>
25453 @end smallexample
25454
25455 @noindent
25456 This minimal description only says that the target uses
25457 the x86-64 architecture.
25458
25459 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
25460 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
25461 are explained further below.
25462
25463 @smallexample
25464 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25465 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
25466 <target>
25467 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
25468 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
25469 </target>
25470 @end smallexample
25471
25472 @noindent
25473 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
25474 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
25475 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
25476 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
25477 useful for XML validation tools.
25478
25479 @subsection Inclusion
25480 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
25481 @cindex XInclude
25482 @ifnotinfo
25483 @cindex <xi:include>
25484 @end ifnotinfo
25485
25486 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
25487 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
25488 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
25489 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
25490 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
25491
25492 @smallexample
25493 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
25494 @end smallexample
25495
25496 @noindent
25497 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
25498 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
25499 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
25500 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
25501 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
25502 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
25503 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
25504 original description.
25505
25506 @subsection Architecture
25507 @cindex <architecture>
25508
25509 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
25510
25511 @smallexample
25512 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
25513 @end smallexample
25514
25515 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
25516 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
25517 Debugging Target}).
25518
25519 @subsection Features
25520 @cindex <feature>
25521
25522 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
25523 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
25524 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
25525 has this form:
25526
25527 @smallexample
25528 <feature name="@var{name}">
25529 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
25530 @var{reg}@dots{}
25531 </feature>
25532 @end smallexample
25533
25534 @noindent
25535 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
25536 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
25537 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
25538 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
25539
25540 @subsection Types
25541
25542 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
25543 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
25544 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
25545 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
25546 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
25547
25548 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
25549 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
25550 Types must be defined before they are used.
25551
25552 @cindex <vector>
25553 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
25554 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
25555 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
25556 @var{count}:
25557
25558 @smallexample
25559 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
25560 @end smallexample
25561
25562 @cindex <union>
25563 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
25564 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
25565 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
25566 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
25567
25568 @smallexample
25569 <union id="@var{id}">
25570 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
25571 @dots{}
25572 </union>
25573 @end smallexample
25574
25575 @subsection Registers
25576 @cindex <reg>
25577
25578 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
25579
25580 @smallexample
25581 <reg name="@var{name}"
25582 bitsize="@var{size}"
25583 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
25584 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
25585 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
25586 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
25587 @end smallexample
25588
25589 @noindent
25590 The components are as follows:
25591
25592 @table @var
25593
25594 @item name
25595 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
25596
25597 @item bitsize
25598 The register's size, in bits.
25599
25600 @item regnum
25601 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
25602 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
25603 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
25604 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
25605 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
25606 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
25607 in order of increasing register number.
25608
25609 @item save-restore
25610 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
25611 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
25612 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
25613 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
25614 ABI.
25615
25616 @item type
25617 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
25618 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
25619 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
25620 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
25621 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
25622 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
25623
25624 @item group
25625 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
25626 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
25627 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
25628 in @code{info registers}.
25629
25630 @end table
25631
25632 @node Predefined Target Types
25633 @section Predefined Target Types
25634 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
25635
25636 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
25637 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
25638 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
25639 types. The currently supported types are:
25640
25641 @table @code
25642
25643 @item int8
25644 @itemx int16
25645 @itemx int32
25646 @itemx int64
25647 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
25648
25649 @item uint8
25650 @itemx uint16
25651 @itemx uint32
25652 @itemx uint64
25653 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
25654
25655 @item code_ptr
25656 @itemx data_ptr
25657 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
25658 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
25659 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
25660 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
25661 may be marked as data pointers.
25662
25663 @item ieee_single
25664 Single precision IEEE floating point.
25665
25666 @item ieee_double
25667 Double precision IEEE floating point.
25668
25669 @item arm_fpa_ext
25670 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
25671
25672 @end table
25673
25674 @node Standard Target Features
25675 @section Standard Target Features
25676 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
25677
25678 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
25679 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
25680 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
25681 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
25682 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
25683 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
25684 can recognize them.
25685
25686 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
25687 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
25688 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
25689 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
25690 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
25691 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
25692 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
25693 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
25694
25695 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
25696 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
25697 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
25698
25699 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
25700 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
25701 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
25702 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
25703
25704 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
25705 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
25706 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
25707
25708 @subsection ARM Features
25709 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
25710
25711 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
25712 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
25713 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
25714
25715 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
25716 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
25717
25718 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
25719 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
25720 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
25721 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
25722
25723 @include gpl.texi
25724
25725 @raisesections
25726 @include fdl.texi
25727 @lowersections
25728
25729 @node Index
25730 @unnumbered Index
25731
25732 @printindex cp
25733
25734 @tex
25735 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25736 % meantime:
25737 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25738 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25739 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25740 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25741 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25742 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25743 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25744 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25745 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25746 \page\colophon
25747 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25748 @end tex
25749
25750 @bye
This page took 0.646665 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.